CYPRESS CY8C5866AXI

PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
®
PRELIMINARY
Programmable System-on-Chip (PSoC )
General Description
With its unique array of configurable blocks, PSoC® 5LP is a true system-level solution providing microcontroller unit (MCU), memory,
analog, and digital peripheral functions in a single chip. The CY8C58LP family offers a modern method of signal acquisition, signal
processing, and control with high accuracy, high bandwidth, and high flexibility. Analog capability spans the range from thermocouples
(near DC voltages) to ultrasonic signals. The CY8C58LP family can handle dozens of data acquisition channels and analog inputs on
every general-purpose input/output (GPIO) pin. The CY8C58LP family is also a high-performance configurable digital system with
some part numbers including interfaces such as USB, multimaster inter-integrated circuit (I2C), and controller area network (CAN).
In addition to communication interfaces,
the CY8C58LP family has an easy to configure logic array, flexible routing to all I/O pins, and
a high-performance 32-bit ARM® Cortex™-M3 microprocessor core. You can easily create system-level designs using a rich library
of prebuilt components and boolean primitives using PSoC Creator™, a hierarchical schematic design entry tool. The CY8C58LP
family provides unparalleled opportunities for analog and digital bill of materials integration while easily accommodating last minute
design changes through simple firmware updates.
❐ Library of advanced peripherals
Features
• Cyclic redundancy check (CRC)
■ 32-bit ARM Cortex-M3 CPU core
• Pseudo random sequence (PRS) generator
❐ DC to 67 MHz operation
• Local interconnect network (LIN) bus 2.0
❐ Flash program memory, up to 256 KB, 100,000 write cycles,
• Quadrature decoder
20-year retention, and multiple security features
■ Analog peripherals (1.71 V ≤ VDDA ≤ 5.5 V)
❐ Up to 32-KB flash error correcting code (ECC) or configuration storage
❐ 1.024 V ±0.1% internal voltage reference across –40°C to
+85°C
❐ Up to 64 KB SRAM
❐ Configurable delta-sigma ADC with 8- to 20-bit resolution
❐ 2-KB electrically erasable programmable read-only memory
(EEPROM) memory, 1 M cycles, and 20 years retention
• Sample rates up to 192 ksps
❐ 24-channel direct memory access (DMA) with multilayer
• Programmable gain stage: ×0.25 to ×16
[1]
AHB bus access
• 12-bit mode, 192 ksps, 66-dB signal to noise and distortion
• Programmable chained descriptors and priorities
ratio (SINAD), ±1-bit INL/DNL
• High bandwidth 32-bit transfer support
• 16-bit mode, 48 ksps, 84-dB SINAD, ±2-bit INL, ±1-bit DNL
■ Low voltage, ultra low power
❐ Up to two SAR ADCs, each 12-bit at 1 Msps
❐ Wide operating voltage range: 0.5 V to 5.5 V
❐ Four 8-bit 8 Msps current IDACs or 1-Msps voltage VDACs
❐ High-efficiency boost regulator from 0.5 V input to 1.8 V to
❐ Four comparators with 95-ns response time
5.0 V output
❐ Four uncommitted opamps with 25-mA drive capability
❐ 3.1 mA at 6 MHz
❐ Four configurable multifunction analog blocks. Example con❐ Low power modes including:
figurations are programmable gain amplifier (PGA), transimpedance amplifier (TIA), mixer, and sample and hold
• 2-µA sleep mode with real time clock (RTC) and low-voltage detect (LVD) interrupt
❐ CapSense support
• 300-nA hibernate mode with RAM retention
■ Programming, debug, and trace
■ Versatile I/O system
❐ JTAG (4 wire), serial wire debug (SWD) (2 wire), single wire
[2]
viewer (SWV), and TRACEPORT interfaces
❐ 28 to 72 I/Os (62 GPIOs, 8 SIOs, 2 USBIOs )
❐ Cortex-M3 flash patch and breakpoint (FPB) block
❐ Any GPIO to any digital or analog peripheral routability
❐ Cortex-M3 Embedded Trace Macrocell™ (ETM™) gener❐ LCD direct drive from any GPIO, up to 46×16 segments
®
[3]
ates an instruction trace stream.
❐ CapSense support from any GPIO
❐ Cortex-M3 data watchpoint and trace (DWT) generates data
❐ 1.2 V to 5.5 V I/O interface voltages, up to 4 domains
trace information
❐ Maskable, independent IRQ on any pin or port
❐ Cortex-M3 Instrumentation Trace Macrocell (ITM) can be
❐ Schmitt-trigger transistor-transistor logic (TTL) inputs
used for printf-style debugging
❐ All GPIOs configurable as open drain high/low,
❐ DWT, ETM, and ITM blocks communicate with off-chip debug
pull-up/pull-down, High-Z, or strong output
and trace systems via the SWV or TRACEPORT
2
❐ Configurable GPIO pin state at power-on reset (POR)
❐ Bootloader programming supportable through I C, SPI,
UART, USB, and other interfaces
❐ 25 mA sink on SIO
■
Digital peripherals
❐ 20 to 24 programmable logic device (PLD) based universal
digital blocks (UDBs)
[2]
❐ Full CAN 2.0b 16 RX, 8 TX buffers
[2]
❐ Full-Speed (FS) USB 2.0 12 Mbps using internal oscillator
❐ Four 16-bit configurable timers, counters, and PWM blocks
❐ 67-MHz, 24-bit fixed point digital filter block (DFB) to
implement finite impulse response (FIR) and infinite impulse
response (IIR) filters
❐ Library of standard peripherals
• 8-, 16-, 24-, and 32-bit timers, counters, and PWMs
• Serial peripheral interface (SPI), universal
asynchronous
transmitter receiver (UART), and I2C
• Many others available in catalog
■
■
Precision, programmable clocking
❐ 3- to 62-MHz internal oscillator over full temperature and voltage range
❐ 4- to 25-MHz crystal oscillator for crystal PPM accuracy
❐ Internal PLL clock generation up to 67 MHz
❐ 32.768-kHz watch crystal oscillator
❐ Low power internal oscillator at 1, 33, and 100 kHz
Temperature and packaging
❐ –40 °C to +85 °C degrees industrial temperature
❐ 68-pin QFN and 100-pin TQFP package options.
Notes
1. AHB – AMBA (advanced microcontroller bus architecture) high-performance bus, an ARM data transfer bus
2. This feature on select devices only. See Ordering Information on page 115 for details.
3. GPIOs with opamp outputs are not recommended for use with CapSense.
Cypress Semiconductor Corporation
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
•
198 Champion Court
•
,
San Jose CA 95134-1709
•
408-943-2600
Revised December 7, 2012
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Contents
1. Architectural Overview ................................................. 3
2. Pinouts ........................................................................... 5
3. Pin Descriptions ............................................................ 9
4. CPU ............................................................................... 11
4.1 ARM Cortex-M3 CPU ...........................................11
4.2 Cache Controller ..................................................12
4.3 DMA and PHUB ...................................................12
4.4 Interrupt Controller ...............................................15
5. Memory ......................................................................... 17
5.1 Static RAM ...........................................................17
5.2 Flash Program Memory ........................................17
5.3 Flash Security .......................................................17
5.4 EEPROM ..............................................................17
5.5 Nonvolatile Latches (NVLs) ..................................18
5.6 External Memory Interface ...................................19
5.7 Memory Map ........................................................20
6. System Integration ...................................................... 21
6.1 Clocking System ...................................................21
6.2 Power System ......................................................24
6.3 Reset ....................................................................28
6.4 I/O System and Routing .......................................29
7. Digital Subsystem ....................................................... 36
7.1 Example Peripherals ............................................36
7.2 Universal Digital Block ..........................................38
7.3 UDB Array Description .........................................41
7.4 DSI Routing Interface Description ........................41
7.5 CAN ......................................................................43
7.6 USB ......................................................................44
7.7 Timers, Counters, and PWMs ..............................44
7.8 I2C ........................................................................45
7.9 Digital Filter Block .................................................46
8. Analog Subsystem ...................................................... 46
8.1 Analog Routing .....................................................48
8.2 Delta-sigma ADC ..................................................50
8.3 Successive Approximation ADC ...........................51
8.4 Comparators .........................................................51
8.5 Opamps ................................................................53
8.6 Programmable SC/CT Blocks ..............................53
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
8.7 LCD Direct Drive ..................................................54
8.8 CapSense .............................................................55
8.9 Temp Sensor ........................................................55
8.10 DAC ....................................................................55
8.11 Up/Down Mixer ...................................................56
8.12 Sample and Hold ................................................56
9. Programming, Debug Interfaces, Resources ............ 57
9.1 JTAG Interface .....................................................57
9.2 SWD Interface ......................................................59
9.3 Debug Features ....................................................60
9.4 Trace Features .....................................................60
9.5 SWV and TRACEPORT Interfaces ......................60
9.6 Programming Features .........................................60
9.7 Device Security ....................................................60
10. Development Support ............................................... 61
10.1 Documentation ...................................................61
10.2 Online .................................................................61
10.3 Tools ...................................................................61
11. Electrical Specifications ........................................... 62
11.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings ................................62
11.2 Device Level Specifications ................................63
11.3 Power Regulators ...............................................65
11.4 Inputs and Outputs .............................................69
11.5 Analog Peripherals .............................................77
11.6 Digital Peripherals ............................................100
11.7 Memory ............................................................104
11.8 PSoC System Resources .................................108
11.9 Clocking ............................................................111
12. Ordering Information ............................................... 115
12.1 Part Numbering Conventions ...........................116
13. Packaging ................................................................. 117
14. Acronyms ................................................................. 119
15. Reference Documents ............................................. 120
16. Document Conventions .......................................... 121
16.1 Units of Measure ..............................................121
17. Revision History ...................................................... 122
18. Sales, Solutions, and Legal Information ............... 122
Page 2 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
1. Architectural Overview
Introducing the CY8C58LP family of ultra low power, flash Programmable System-on-Chip (PSoC) devices, part of a scalable 8-bit
PSoC 3 and 32-bit PSoC 5LP platform. The CY8C58LP family provides configurable blocks of analog, digital, and interconnect circuitry
around a CPU subsystem. The combination of a CPU with a flexible analog subsystem, digital subsystem, routing, and I/O enables
a high level of integration in a wide variety of consumer, industrial, and medical applications.
Figure 1-1. Simplified Block Diagram
Analog Interconnect
Clock Tree
IMO
Digital System
Quadrature Decoder
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
I 2C Slave
Sequencer
Universal Digital Block Array (24 x UDB)
8- Bit
Timer
16- Bit
PWM
UDB
8- Bit SPI
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
22 Ω
UDB
UDB
FS USB
2.0
4x
Timer
Counter
PWM
12- Bit SPI
UDB
Master/
Slave
UDB
UDB
8- Bit
Timer
Logic
UDB
UDB
I2C
CAN
2.0
16- Bit PRS
Logic
UDB
UDB
UART
UDB
UDB
USB
PHY
GPIOs
32.768 KHz
( Optional)
GPIOs
Xtal
Osc
SIO
System Wide
Resources
Usage Example for UDB
4- 25 MHz
( Optional)
GPIOs
Digital Interconnect
12- Bit PWM
RTC
Timer
WDT
and
Wake
EEPROM
SRAM
EMIF
FLASH
CPU System
Interrupt
Controller
Cortex M3CPU
Program &
Debug
GPIOs
System Bus
Memory System
Program
GPIOs
Debug &
Trace
ILO
Cache
Controller
PHUB
DMA
Boundary
Scan
LCD Direct
Drive
Digital
Filter
Block
POR and
LVD
1.71 to
5.5 V
Sleep
Power
1.8 V LDO
SMP
4 x SC / CT Blocks
(TIA, PGA, Mixer etc)
Temperature
Sensor
GPIOs
Power Management
System
Analog System
ADCs
2x
SAR
ADC
+
4x
Opamp
-
+
4x DAC
CapSense
1x
Del Sig
ADC
4x
CMP
-
3 per
Opamp
GPIOs
SIOs
Clocking System
0. 5 to 5.5 V
( Optional)
Figure 1-1 illustrates the major components of the CY8C58LP
family. They are:
■
ARM Cortex-M3 CPU subsystem
■
Nonvolatile subsystem
■
Programming, debug, and test subsystem
■
Inputs and outputs
■
Clocking
■
Power
■
Digital subsystem
■
Analog subsystem
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
PSoC’s digital subsystem provides half of its unique
configurability. It connects a digital signal from any peripheral to
any pin through the digital system interconnect (DSI). It also
provides functional flexibility through an array of small, fast, low
power UDBs. PSoC Creator provides a library of pre-built and
tested standard digital peripherals (UART, SPI, LIN, PRS, CRC,
timer, counter, PWM, AND, OR, and so on) that are mapped to
the UDB array. You can also easily create a digital circuit using
boolean primitives by means of graphical design entry. Each
UDB contains programmable array logic (PAL)/programmable
logic device (PLD) functionality, together with a small state
machine engine to support a wide variety of peripherals.
Page 3 of 122
PRELIMINARY
In addition to the flexibility of the UDB array, PSoC also provides
configurable digital blocks targeted at specific functions. For the
CY8C58LP family, these blocks can include four 16-bit timers,
counters, and PWM blocks; I2C slave, master, and multimaster;
Full-Speed USB; and Full CAN 2.0b.
For more details on the peripherals see the “Example
Peripherals” section on page 36 of this datasheet. For
information on UDBs, DSI, and other digital blocks, see the
“Digital Subsystem” section on page 36 of this datasheet.
PSoC’s analog subsystem is the second half of its unique
configurability. All analog performance is based on a highly
accurate absolute voltage reference with less than 0.1% error
over temperature and voltage. The configurable analog
subsystem includes:
■
Analog muxes
■
Comparators
■
Analog mixers
■
Voltage references
■
ADCs
■
DACs
■
Digital filter block (DFB)
All GPIO pins can route analog signals into and out of the device
using the internal analog bus. This allows the device to interface
up to 62 discrete analog signals. One of the ADCs in the analog
subsystem is a fast, accurate, configurable delta-sigma ADC
with these features:
■
Less than 100-µV offset
■
A gain error of 0.2%
■
Integral non linearity (INL) less than ±2 LSB
■
Differential non linearity (DNL) less than ±1 LSB
SINAD better than 84 dB in 16-bit mode
■
This converter addresses a wide variety of precision analog
applications including some of the most demanding sensors.
The CY8C58LP family also offers up to two SAR ADCs.
Featuring 12-bit conversions at up to 1 M samples per second,
they also offer low nonlinearity and offset errors and SNR better
than 70 dB. They are well-suited for a variety of higher speed
analog applications.
The output of any of the ADCs can optionally feed the
programmable DFB via DMA without CPU intervention. You can
configure the DFB to perform IIR and FIR digital filters and
several user defined custom functions. The DFB can implement
filters with up to 64 taps. It can perform a 48-bit
multiply-accumulate (MAC) operation in one clock cycle.
Four high-speed voltage or current DACs support 8-bit output
signals at an update rate of up to 8 Msps. They can be routed
out of any GPIO pin. You can create higher resolution voltage
PWM DAC outputs using the UDB array. This can be used to
create a pulse width modulated (PWM) DAC of up to 10 bits, at
up to 48 kHz. The digital DACs in each UDB support PWM, PRS,
or delta-sigma algorithms with programmable widths.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
In addition to the ADCs, DACs, and DFB, the analog subsystem
provides multiple:
■
Comparators
■
Uncommitted opamps
Configurable switched capacitor/continuous time (SC/CT)
blocks. These support:
❐ Transimpedance amplifiers
❐ Programmable gain amplifiers
❐ Mixers
❐ Other similar analog components
See the “Analog Subsystem” section on page 46 of this
datasheet for more details.
■
PSoC’s CPU subsystem is built around a 32-bit three-stage
pipelined ARM Cortex-M3 processor running at up to 67 MHz.
The Cortex-M3 includes a tightly integrated nested vectored
interrupt controller (NVIC) and various debug and trace modules.
The overall CPU subsystem includes a DMA controller, flash
cache, and RAM. The NVIC provides low latency, nested
interrupts, and tail-chaining of interrupts and other features to
increase the efficiency of interrupt handling. The DMA controller
enables peripherals to exchange data without CPU involvement.
This allows the CPU to run slower (saving power) or use those
CPU cycles to improve the performance of firmware algorithms.
The flash cache also reduces system power consumption by
allowing less frequent flash access.
PSoC’s nonvolatile subsystem consists of flash, byte-writeable
EEPROM, and nonvolatile configuration options. It provides up
to 256 KB of on-chip flash. The CPU can reprogram individual
blocks of flash, enabling boot loaders. You can enable an ECC
for high reliability applications. A powerful and flexible protection
model secures the user's sensitive information, allowing
selective memory block locking for read and write protection.
Two KB of byte-writable EEPROM is available on-chip to store
application data. Additionally, selected configuration options
such as boot speed and pin drive mode are stored in nonvolatile
memory. This allows settings to activate immediately after POR.
The three types of PSoC I/O are extremely flexible. All I/Os have
many drive modes that are set at POR. PSoC also provides up
to four I/O voltage domains through the VDDIO pins. Every GPIO
has analog I/O, LCD drive, CapSense, flexible interrupt
generation, slew rate control, and digital I/O capability. The SIOs
on PSoC allow VOH to be set independently of VDDIO when used
as outputs. When SIOs are in input mode they are high
impedance. This is true even when the device is not powered or
when the pin voltage goes above the supply voltage. This makes
the SIO ideally suited for use on an I2C bus where the PSoC may
not be powered when other devices on the bus are. The SIO pins
also have high current sink capability for applications such as
LED drives. The programmable input threshold feature of the
SIO can be used to make the SIO function as a general purpose
analog comparator. For devices with FS USB, the USB physical
interface is also provided (USBIO). When not using USB, these
pins may also be used for limited digital functionality and device
programming. All the features of the PSoC I/Os are covered in
detail in the “I/O System and Routing” section on page 29 of this
datasheet.
Page 4 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
The PSoC device incorporates flexible internal clock generators,
designed for high stability and factory trimmed for high accuracy.
The internal main oscillator (IMO) is the master clock base for
the system, and has one-percent accuracy at 3 MHz. The IMO
can be configured to run from 3 MHz up to 62 MHz. Multiple clock
derivatives can be generated from the main clock frequency to
meet application needs. The device provides a PLL to generate
system clock frequencies up to 67 MHz from the IMO, external
crystal, or external reference clock. It also contains a separate,
very low-power internal low-speed oscillator (ILO) for the sleep
and watchdog timers. A 32.768-kHz external watch crystal is
also supported for use in RTC applications. The clocks, together
with programmable clock dividers, provide the flexibility to
integrate most timing requirements.
The CY8C58LP family supports a wide supply operating range
from 1.71 to 5.5 V. This allows operation from regulated supplies
such as 1.8 ± 5%, 2.5 V ±10%, 3.3 V ± 10%, or 5.0 V ± 10%, or
directly from a wide range of battery types. In addition, it provides
an integrated high efficiency synchronous boost converter that
can power the device from supply voltages as low as 0.5 V. This
enables the device to be powered directly from a single battery.
In addition, you can use the boost converter to generate other
voltages required by the device, such as a 3.3 V supply for LCD
glass drive. The boost’s output is available on the VBOOST pin,
allowing other devices in the application to be powered from the
PSoC.
PSoC supports a wide range of low power modes. These include
a 300-nA hibernate mode with RAM retention and a 2-µA sleep
mode with RTC. In the second mode, the optional 32.768-kHz
watch crystal runs continuously and maintains an accurate RTC.
Power to all major functional blocks, including the programmable
digital and analog peripherals, can be controlled independently
by firmware. This allows low power background processing
when some peripherals are not in use. This, in turn, provides a
total device current of only 3.1 mA when the CPU is running at
6 MHz.
The details of the PSoC power modes are covered in the “Power
System” section on page 24 of this datasheet.
PSoC uses JTAG (4 wire) or SWD (2 wire) interfaces for
programming, debug, and test. Using these standard interfaces
you can debug or program the PSoC with a variety of hardware
solutions from Cypress or third party vendors. The Cortex-M3
debug and trace modules include FPB, DWT, ETM, and ITM.
These modules have many features to help solve difficult debug
and trace problems. Details of the programming, test, and
debugging interfaces are discussed in the “Programming, Debug
Interfaces, Resources” section on page 57 of this datasheet.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
2. Pinouts
Each VDDIO pin powers a specific set of I/O pins. (The USBIOs
are powered from VDDD.) Using the VDDIO pins, a single PSoC
can support multiple voltage levels, reducing the need for
off-chip level shifters. The black lines drawn on the pinout
diagrams in Figure 2-3 and Figure 2-4 show the pins that are
powered by each VDDIO.
Each VDDIO may source up to 100 mA total to its associated I/O
pins, as shown in Figure 2-1.
Figure 2-1. VDDIO Current Limit
IDDIO X = 100 mA
VDDIO X
I/O Pins
PSoC
Conversely, for the 100-pin and 68-pin devices, the set of I/O
pins associated with any VDDIO may sink up to 100 mA total, as
shown in Figure 2-2.
Figure 2-2. I/O Pins Current Limit
Ipins = 100 mA
VDDIO X
I/O Pins
PSoC
VSSD
Page 5 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
P2[5] (GPIO, TRACEDATA[1])
VDDIO2
P2[4] (GPIO, TRACEDATA[0])
P2[3] (GPIO, TRACECLK)
P2[2] (GPIO)
P2[1] (GPIO)
P2[0] (GPIO)
P15[5] (GPOI)
P15[4] (GPIO)
VDDD
VSSD
VCCD
P0[7] (GPIO, IDAC2)
P0[6] (GPIO, IDAC0)
P0[5] (GPIO, OPAMP2-)
P0[4] (GPIO, OPAMP2+, SAR0 EXTREF)
VDDIO0
Figure 2-3. 68-pin QFN Part Pinout[4]
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
51
50
Lines show VDDIO
to I/O supply
association
QFN
(TOP VIEW)
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
P0[3] (GPIO, OPAMP0-, EXTREF0)
P0[2] (GPIO, OPAMP0+, SAR1 EXTREF)
P0[1] (GPIO, OPAMP0OUT)
P0[0] (GPIO, OPAMP2OUT)
P12[3] (SIO)
P12[2] (SIO)
VSSD
VDDA
VSSA
VCCA
P15[3] (GPIO, KHZ XTAL: XI)
P15[2] (GPIO, KHZ XTAL: XO)
P12[1] (SIO, I2C1: SDA)
P12[0] (SIO, 12C1: SCL)
P3[7] (GPIO, OPAMP3OUT)
P3[6] (GPIO, OPAMP1OUT)
VDDIO3
(GPIO) P1[6]
(GPIO) P1[7]
(SIO) P12[6]
(SIO) P12[7]
[5]
(USBIO, D+, SWDIO) P15[6]
[5] (USBIO, D-, SWDCK) P15[7]
VDDD
VSSD
VCCD
(MHZ XTAL: XO, GPIO) P15[0]
(MHZ XTAL: XI, GPIO) P15[1]
(IDAC1, GPIO) P3[0]
(IDAC3, GPIO) P3[1]
(OPAMP3-, EXTREF1, GPIO) P3[2]
(OPAMP3+, GPIO) P3[3]
(OPAMP1-, GPIO) P3[4]
(OPAMP1+, GPIO) P3[5]
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
(TRACEDATA[2], GPIO) P2[6]
(TRACEDATA[3], GPIO) P2[7]
(I2C0: SCL, SIO) P12[4]
(I2C0: SDA, SIO) P12[5]
VSSB
IND
VBOOST
VBAT
VSSD
XRES
(TMS, SWDIO, GPIO) P1[0]
(TCK, SWDCK, GPIO) P1[1]
(Configurable XRES, GPIO) P1[2]
(TDO, SWV, GPIO) P1[3]
(TDI, GPIO) P1[4]
(NTRST, GPIO) P1[5]
VDDIO1
Notes
4. The center pad on the QFN package should be connected to digital ground (VSSD) for best mechanical, thermal, and electrical performance. If not connected to
ground, it should be electrically floated and not connected to any other signal.
5. Pins are Do Not Use (DNU) on devices without USB. The pin must be left floating.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 6 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
P4[5] (GPIO)
P4[4] (GPIO)
P4[3] (GPIO)
P4[2] (GPIO)
P0[7] (GPIO, IDAC2)
P0[6] (GPIO, IDAC0)
P0[5] (GPIO, OPAMP2-)
P0[4] (GPIO, OPAMP2+, SAR0 EXTREF)
P15[4] (GPIO)
P6[3] (GPIO)
P6[2] (GPIO)
P6[1] (GPIO)
P6[0] (GPIO)
VDDD
VSSD
VCCD
P4[7] (GPIO)
P4[6] (GPIO)
75
74
Lines show VDDIO
to I/O supply
association
TQFP
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
[6]
[6]
VDDIO0
P0[3] (GPIO, OPAMP0-, EXTREF0)
P0[2] (GPIO, OPAMP0+, SAR1 EXTREF)
P0[1] (GPIO, OPAMP0OUT)
P0[0] (GPIO, OPAMP2OUT)
P4[1] (GPIO)
P4[0] (GPIO)
P12[3] (SIO)
P12[2] (SIO)
VSSD
VDDA
VSSA
VCCA
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
P15[3] (GPIO, KHZ XTAL: XI)
P15[2] (GPIO, KHZ XTAL: XO)
P12[1] (SIO, I2C1: SDA)
P12[0] (SIO, I2C1: SCL)
P3[7] (GPIO, OPAMP3OUT)
P3[6] (GPIO, OPAMP1OUT)
(OPAMP1+, GPIO) P3[5]
VDDIO3
(USBIO, D-, SWDCK) P15[7]
VDDD
VSSD
VCCD
NC
NC
(MHZ XTAL: XO, GPIO) P15[0]
(MHZ XTAL: XI, GPIO) P15[1]
(IDAC1, GPIO) P3[0]
(IDAC3, GPIO) P3[1]
(OPAMP3-, EXTREF1, GPIO) P3[2]
(OPAMP3+, GPIO) P3[3]
(OPAMP1-, GPIO) P3[4]
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
VDDIO1
(GPIO) P1[6]
(GPIO) P1[7]
(SIO) P12[6]
(SIO) P12[7]
(GPIO) P5[4]
(GPIO) P5[5]
(GPIO) P5[6]
(GPIO) P5[7]
(USBIO, D+, SWDIO) P15[6]
(TRACEDATA[1], GPIO) P2[5]
(TRACEDATA[2], GPIO) P2[6]
(TRACEDATA[3], GPIO) P2[7]
(I2C0: SCL, SIO) P12[4]
(I2C0: SDA, SIO) P12[5]
(GPIO) P6[4]
(GPIO) P6[5]
(GPIO) P6[6]
(GPIO) P6[7]
VSSB
IND
VBOOST
VBAT
VSSD
XRES
(GPIO) P5[0]
(GPIO) P5[1]
(GPIO) P5[2]
(GPIO) P5[3]
(TMS, SWDIO, GPIO) P1[0]
(TCK, SWDCK, GPIO) P1[1]
(Configurable XRES, GPIO) P1[2]
(TDO, SWV, GPIO) P1[3]
(TDI, GPIO) P1[4]
(NTRST, GPIO) P1[5]
100
99
98
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
90
89
88
87
86
85
84
83
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
VDDIO2
P2[4] (GPIO, TRACEDATA[0])
P2[3] (GPIO, TRACECLK)
P2[2] (GPIO)
P2[1] (GPIO)
P2[0] (GPIO)
P15[5] (GPIO)
Figure 2-4. 100-pin TQFP Part Pinout
Figure 2-5 on page 8 and Figure 2-6 on page 9 show an example schematic and an example PCB layout, for the 100-pin TQFP part,
for optimal analog performance on a two-layer board.
■
The two pins labeled VDDD must be connected together.
■
The two pins labeled VCCD must be connected together, with capacitance added, as shown in Figure 2-5 and “Power System”
section on page 24. The trace between the two VCCD pins should be as short as possible.
■
The two pins labeled VSSD must be connected together.
For information on circuit board layout issues for mixed signals, refer to the application note, AN57821 - Mixed Signal Circuit Board
Layout Considerations for PSoC® 3 and PSoC 5.
Notes
6. Pins are Do Not Use (DNU) on devices without USB. The pin must be left floating.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 7 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
Figure 2-5. Example Schematic for 100-pin TQFP Part with Power Connections
VDDD
VDDD
C1
1 UF
VDDD
C2
0.1 UF
VSSD
VDDIO0
OA0-, REF0, P0[3]
OA0+, SAR1REF, P0[2]
OA0OUT, P0[1]
OA2OUT, P0[0]
P4[1]
P4[0]
SIO, P12[3]
SIO, P12[2]
VSSD
VDDA
VSSA
VCCA
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
NC
KHZXIN, P15[3]
KHZXOUT, P15[2]
SIO, P12[1]
SIO, P12[0]
OA3OUT, P3[7]
VSSD
VSSD
VDDD
C12
0.1 UF
C15
1 UF
C16
0.1 UF
VDDA
VDDD
C8
0.1 UF
C17
1 UF
VSSD
VSSD
VDDA
VSSA
VCCA
VSSD
VSSA
VDDA
C9
1 UF
C10
0.1 UF
VSSA
VDDIO3
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
VDDD
C11
0.1 UF
VCCD
VDDD
OA1OUT, P3[6]
P3[5], OA1+
VDDIO1
P1[6]
P1[7]
P12[6], SIO
P12[7], SIO
P5[4]
P5[5]
P5[6]
P5[7]
USB D+, P15[6]
USB D-, P15[7]
VDDD
VSSD
VCCD
NC
NC
P15[0], MHZXOUT
P15[1], MHZXIN
P3[0], IDAC1
P3[1], IDAC3
P3[2], OA3-, REF1
P3[3], OA3+
P3[4], OA1-
P2[5]
P2[6]
P2[7]
P12[4], SIO
P12[5], SIO
P6[4]
P6[5]
P6[6]
P6[7]
VSSB
IND
VBOOST
VBAT
VSSD
XRES
P5[0]
P5[1]
P5[2]
P5[3]
P1[0], SWDIO, TMS
P1[1], SWDCK, TCK
P1[2]
P1[3], SWV, TDO
P1[4], TDI
P1[5], NTRST
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
VSSD
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
VSSD 14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
VSSD
VDDIO2
P2[4]
P2[3]
P2[2]
P2[1]
P2[0]
P15[5]
P15[4]
P6[3]
P6[2]
P6[1]
P6[0]
VDDD
VSSD
VCCD
P4[7]
P4[6]
P4[5]
P4[4]
P4[3]
P4[2]
IDAC2, P0[7]
IDAC0, P0[6]
OA2-, P0[5]
OA2+,
SAR0REF,
P0[4]
VSSD
VDDD
100
99
98
97
96
95
94
93
92
91
90
89
88 VDDD
VSSD
87
86
85
84
83
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
VCCD
C6
0.1 UF
VSSD
VSSD
Note The two VCCD pins must be connected together with as short a trace as possible. A trace under the device is recommended, as
shown in Figure 2-6.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 8 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 2-6. Example PCB Layout for 100-pin TQFP Part for Optimal Analog Performance
VSSA
VDDD
VSSD
VDDA
VSSA
P lan e
VSSD
P lan e
3. Pin Descriptions
IDAC0, IDAC1, IDAC2, IDAC3. Low-resistance output pin for
high-current DACs (IDAC).
Opamp0out, Opamp1out, Opamp2out, Opamp3out. High
current output of uncommitted opamp.[7]
Extref0, Extref1. External reference input to the analog system.
SAR0 EXTREF, SAR1 EXTREF. External references for SAR
ADCs
Opamp0-, Opamp1-, Opamp2-, Opamp3-. Inverting input to
uncommitted opamp.
Opamp0+, Opamp1+, Opamp2+, Opamp3+. Noninverting
input to uncommitted opamp.
GPIO. Provides interfaces to the CPU, digital peripherals,
analog peripherals, interrupts, LCD segment drive, and
CapSense.[7]
I2C0: SCL, I2C1: SCL. I2C SCL line providing wake from sleep
on an address match. Any I/O pin can be used for I2C SCL if
wake from sleep is not required.
I2C0: SDA, I2C1: SDA. I2C SDA line providing wake from sleep
on an address match. Any I/O pin can be used for I2C SDA if
wake from sleep is not required.
Ind. Inductor connection to boost pump.
kHz XTAL: Xo, kHz XTAL: Xi. 32.768-kHz crystal oscillator pin.
MHz XTAL: Xo, MHz XTAL: Xi. 4 to 25-MHz crystal oscillator
pin.
nTRST. Optional JTAG Test Reset programming and debug port
connection to reset the JTAG connection.
SIO. Provides interfaces to the CPU, digital peripherals and
interrupts with a programmable high threshold voltage, analog
comparator, high sink current, and high impedance state when
the device is unpowered.
SWDCK. SWD Clock programming and debug port connection.
SWDIO. SWD Input and Output programming and debug port
connection.
TCK. JTAG Test Clock programming and debug port connection.
TDI. JTAG Test Data In programming and debug port
connection.
TDO. JTAG Test Data Out programming and debug port
connection.
TMS. JTAG Test Mode Select programming and debug port
connection.
TRACECLK. Cortex-M3
TRACEDATA pins.
TRACEPORT
TRACEDATA[3:0]. Cortex-M3
output data.
connection,
TRACEPORT
clocks
connections,
SWV. SWV output.
USBIO, D+. Provides D+ connection directly to a USB 2.0 bus.
May be used as a digital I/O pin; it is powered from VDDD instead
of from a VDDIO. Pins are Do Not Use (DNU) on devices without
USB.
USBIO, D-. Provides D- connection directly to a USB 2.0 bus.
May be used as a digital I/O pin; it is powered from VDDD instead
of from a VDDIO. Pins are Do Not Use (DNU) on devices without
USB.
VBOOST. Power sense connection to boost pump.
Notes
7. GPIOs with opamp outputs are not recommended for use with CapSense.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 9 of 122
PRELIMINARY
VBAT. Battery supply to boost pump.
VCCA. Output of the analog core regulator or the input to
the analog core. Requires a 1uF capacitor to VSSA. The
regulator output is not designed to drive external circuits. Note
that if you use the device with an external core regulator
(externally regulated mode), the voltage applied to this pin
must not exceed the allowable range of 1.71 V to 1.89 V.
When using the internal core regulator, (internally regulated
mode, the default), do not tie any power to this pin. For details
see “Power System” section on page 24.
VCCD. Output of the digital core regulator or the input to the
digital core. The two VCCD pins must be shorted together, with
the trace between them as short as possible, and a 1uF capacitor
to VSSD. The regulator output is not designed to drive external
circuits. Note that if you use the device with an external core
regulator (externally regulated mode), the voltage applied to
this pin must not exceed the allowable range of 1.71 V to
1.89 V. When using the internal core regulator (internally
regulated mode, the default), do not tie any power to this pin. For
details see “Power System” section on page 24.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
VDDA. Supply for all analog peripherals and analog core
regulator. VDDA must be the highest voltage present on the
device. All other supply pins must be less than or equal to
VDDA.
VDDD. Supply for all digital peripherals and digital core
regulator. VDDD must be less than or equal to VDDA.
VSSA. Ground for all analog peripherals.
VSSB. Ground connection for boost pump.
VSSD. Ground for all digital logic and I/O pins.
VDDIO0, VDDIO1, VDDIO2, VDDIO3. Supply for I/O pins. Each
VDDIO must be tied to a valid operating voltage (1.71 V to 5.5 V),
and must be less than or equal to VDDA.
XRES (and configurable XRES). External reset pin. Active low
with internal pull-up. Pin P1[2] may be configured to be a XRES
pin; see “Nonvolatile Latches (NVLs)” on page 18.
Page 10 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
4. CPU
4.1 ARM Cortex-M3 CPU
The CY8C58LP family of devices has an ARM Cortex-M3 CPU core. The Cortex-M3 is a low-power 32-bit three-stage pipelined
Harvard-architecture CPU that delivers 1.25 DMIPS/MHz. It is intended for deeply embedded applications that require fast interrupt
handling features.
Figure 4-1. ARM Cortex-M3 Block Diagram
Interrupt Inputs
Nested
Vectored
Interrupt
Controller
(NVIC)
I- Bus
JTAG/SWD
D-Bus
Embedded
Trace Module
(ETM)
Instrumentation
Trace Module
(ITM)
S-Bus
Trace Pins:
Debug Block
(Serial and
JTAG)
Flash Patch
and Breakpoint
(FPB)
Trace Port
5 for TRACEPORT or
Interface Unit 1 for SWV mode
(TPIU)
Cortex M3 Wrapper
C-Bus
AHB
32 KB
SRAM
Data
Watchpoint and
Trace (DWT)
Cortex M3 CPU Core
AHB
Bus
Matrix
Bus
Matrix
Cache
256 KB
ECC
Flash
AHB
32 KB
SRAM
Bus
Matrix
AHB Bridge & Bus Matrix
DMA
PHUB
AHB Spokes
GPIO &
EMIF
Prog.
Digital
Prog.
Analog
Special
Functions
Peripherals
The Cortex-M3 CPU subsystem includes these features:
4.1.1 Cortex-M3 Features
■
ARM Cortex-M3 CPU
The Cortex-M3 CPU features include:
■
Programmable nested vectored interrupt controller (NVIC),
tightly integrated with the CPU core
■
■
Full featured debug and trace modules, tightly integrated with
the CPU core
■
Up to 256 KB of flash memory, 2 KB of EEPROM, and 64 KB
of SRAM
■
Cache controller
■
Peripheral HUB (PHUB)
■
DMA controller
■
External memory interface (EMIF)
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
■
4 GB address space. Predefined address regions for code,
data, and peripherals. Multiple buses for efficient and
simultaneous accesses of instructions, data, and peripherals.
The Thumb®-2 instruction set, which offers ARM-level
performance at Thumb-level code density. This includes 16-bit
and 32-bit instructions. Advanced instructions include:
❐ Bit-field control
❐ Hardware multiply and divide
❐ Saturation
❐ If-Then
❐ Wait for events and interrupts
❐ Exclusive access and barrier
❐ Special register access
Page 11 of 122
PRELIMINARY
The Cortex-M3 does not support ARM instructions for SRAM
addresses.
■
Bit-band support for the SRAM region. Atomic bit-level write
and read operations for SRAM addresses.
■
Unaligned data storage and access. Contiguous storage of
data of different byte lengths.
■
Operation at two privilege levels (privileged and user) and in
two modes (thread and handler). Some instructions can only
be executed at the privileged level. There are also two stack
pointers: Main (MSP) and Process (PSP). These features
support a multitasking operating system running one or more
user-level processes.
■
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 4-2. Cortex M3 CPU Registers (continued)
Register
R14
R15
xPSR
Extensive interrupt and system exception support.
Description
R14 is the link register (LR). The LR stores the return
address when a subroutine is called.
R15 is the program counter (PC). Bit 0 of the PC is
ignored and considered to be 0, so instructions are
always aligned to a half word (2 byte) boundary.
The program status registers are divided into three
status registers, which are accessed either together
or separately:
■
Application program status register (APSR) holds
program execution status bits such as zero, carry,
negative, in bits[27:31].
■
Interrupt program status register (IPSR) holds the
current exception number in bits[0:8].
4.1.3 CPU Registers
Execution program status register (EPSR) holds
control bits for interrupt continuable and IF-THEN
instructions in bits[10:15] and [25:26]. Bit 24 is
always set to 1 to indicate Thumb mode. Trying to
clear it causes a fault exception.
PRIMASK
A 1-bit interrupt mask register. When set, it allows
only the nonmaskable interrupt (NMI) and hard fault
exception. All other exceptions and interrupts are
masked.
FAULTMASK A 1-bit interrupt mask register. When set, it allows
only the NMI. All other exceptions and interrupts are
masked.
BASEPRI
A register of up to nine bits that define the masking
priority level. When set, it disables all interrupts of
the same or higher priority value. If set to 0 then the
masking function is disabled.
CONTROL
A 2-bit register for controlling the operating mode.
Bit 0: 0 = privileged level in thread mode,
1 = user level in thread mode.
Bit 1: 0 = default stack (MSP) is used,
1 = alternate stack is used. If in thread mode or user
level then the alternate stack is the PSP. There is no
alternate stack for handler mode; the bit must be 0
while in handler mode.
The Cortex-M3 CPU registers are listed in Table 4-2. Registers
R0-R15 are all 32 bits wide.
4.2 Cache Controller
4.1.2 Cortex-M3 Operating Modes
■
The Cortex-M3 operates at either the privileged level or the user
level, and in either the thread mode or the handler mode.
Because the handler mode is only enabled at the privileged level,
there are actually only three states, as shown in Table 4-1.
Table 4-1. Operational Level
Condition
Privileged
User
Running an exception Handler mode
Not used
Running main program Thread mode
Thread mode
At the user level, access to certain instructions, special registers,
configuration registers, and debugging components is blocked.
Attempts to access them cause a fault exception. At the
privileged level, access to all instructions and registers is
allowed.
The processor runs in the handler mode (always at the privileged
level) when handling an exception, and in the thread mode when
not.
Table 4-2. Cortex M3 CPU Registers
Register
R0-R12
Description
General purpose registers R0-R12 have no special
architecturally defined uses. Most instructions that
specify a general purpose register specify R0-R12.
■
Low registers: Registers R0-R7 are accessible by
all instructions that specify a general purpose
register.
High registers: Registers R8-R12 are accessible
by all 32-bit instructions that specify a general
purpose register; they are not accessible by all
16-bit instructions.
R13 is the stack pointer register. It is a banked
register that switches between two 32-bit stack
pointers: the main stack pointer (MSP) and the
process stack pointer (PSP). The PSP is used only
when the CPU operates at the user level in thread
mode. The MSP is used in all other privilege levels
and modes. Bits[0:1] of the SP are ignored and
considered to be 0, so the SP is always aligned to a
word (4 byte) boundary.
■
R13
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
The CY8C58LP family has a 1 KB instruction cache between the
CPU and the flash memory. This improves instruction execution
rate and reduces system power consumption by requiring less
frequent flash access.
4.3 DMA and PHUB
The PHUB and the DMA controller are responsible for data
transfer between the CPU and peripherals, and also data
transfers between peripherals. The PHUB and DMA also control
device configuration during boot. The PHUB consists of:
■
A central hub that includes the DMA controller, arbiter, and
router
■
Multiple spokes that radiate outward from the hub to most
peripherals
There are two PHUB masters: the CPU and the DMA controller.
Both masters may initiate transactions on the bus. The DMA
channels can handle peripheral communication without CPU
intervention. The arbiter in the central hub determines which
DMA channel is the highest priority if there are multiple requests.
Page 12 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
4.3.3 Priority Levels
4.3.1 PHUB Features
■
CPU and DMA controller are both bus masters to the PHUB
■
Eight multi-layer AHB bus parallel access paths (spokes) for
peripheral access
■
Simultaneous CPU and DMA access to peripherals located on
different spokes
■
Simultaneous DMA source and destination burst transactions
on different spokes
■
Supports 8-, 16-, 24-, and 32-bit addressing and data
Table 4-3. PHUB Spokes and Peripherals
PHUB Spokes
Peripherals
0
SRAM
1
IOs, PICU, EMIF
2
PHUB local configuration, Power manager,
Clocks, IC, SWV, EEPROM, Flash
programming interface
3
Analog interface and trim, Decimator
4
USB, CAN, I2C, Timers, Counters, and PWMs
5
DFB
6
UDBs group 1
7
UDBs group 2
The CPU always has higher priority than the DMA controller
when their accesses require the same bus resources. Due to the
system architecture, the CPU can never starve the DMA. DMA
channels of higher priority (lower priority number) may interrupt
current DMA transfers. In the case of an interrupt, the current
transfer is allowed to complete its current transaction. To ensure
latency limits when multiple DMA accesses are requested
simultaneously, a fairness algorithm guarantees an interleaved
minimum percentage of bus bandwidth for priority levels 2
through 7. Priority levels 0 and 1 do not take part in the fairness
algorithm and may use 100% of the bus bandwidth. If a tie occurs
on two DMA requests of the same priority level, a simple round
robin method is used to evenly share the allocated bandwidth.
The round robin allocation can be disabled for each DMA
channel, allowing it to always be at the head of the line. Priority
levels 2 to 7 are guaranteed the minimum bus bandwidth shown
in Table 4-4 after the CPU and DMA priority levels 0 and 1 have
satisfied their requirements.
Table 4-4. Priority Levels
Priority Level
% Bus Bandwidth
0
100.0
1
100.0
2
50.0
3
25.0
4
12.5
4.3.2 DMA Features
5
6.2
■
24 DMA channels
6
3.1
■
Each channel has one or more transaction descriptors (TDs)
to configure channel behavior. Up to 128 total TDs can be
defined
7
1.5
■
TDs can be dynamically updated
■
Eight levels of priority per channel
■
Any digitally routable signal, the CPU, or another DMA channel,
can trigger a transaction
■
Each channel can generate up to two interrupts per transfer
■
Transactions can be stalled or canceled
The flexible configuration of each DMA channel and the ability to
chain multiple channels allow the creation of both simple and
complex use cases. General use cases include, but are not
limited to:
■
Supports transaction size of infinite or 1 to 64k bytes
4.3.4.1 Simple DMA
■
Large transactions may be broken into smaller bursts of 1 to
127 bytes
■
TDs may be nested and/or chained for complex transactions
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
When the fairness algorithm is disabled, DMA access is granted
based solely on the priority level; no bus bandwidth guarantees
are made.
4.3.4 Transaction Modes Supported
In a simple DMA case, a single TD transfers data between a
source and sink (peripherals or memory location). The basic
timing diagrams of DMA read and write cycles are shown in
Figure 4-2. For more description on other transfer modes, refer
to the Technical Reference Manual.
Page 13 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 4-2. DMA Timing Diagram
ADDRESS Phase
DATA Phase
ADDRESS Phase
CLK
ADDR 16/32
DATA Phase
CLK
A
B
A
ADDR 16/32
WRITE
B
WRITE
DATA (A)
DATA
READY
DATA (A)
DATA
READY
Basic DMA Read Transfer without wait states
4.3.4.2 Auto Repeat DMA
Auto repeat DMA is typically used when a static pattern is
repetitively read from system memory and written to a peripheral.
This is done with a single TD that chains to itself.
4.3.4.3 Ping Pong DMA
A ping pong DMA case uses double buffering to allow one buffer
to be filled by one client while another client is consuming the
data previously received in the other buffer. In its simplest form,
this is done by chaining two TDs together so that each TD calls
the opposite TD when complete.
4.3.4.4 Circular DMA
Circular DMA is similar to ping pong DMA except it contains more
than two buffers. In this case there are multiple TDs; after the last
TD is complete it chains back to the first TD.
4.3.4.5 Indexed DMA
In an indexed DMA case, an external master requires access to
locations on the system bus as if those locations were shared
memory. As an example, a peripheral may be configured as an
SPI or I2C slave where an address is received by the external
master. That address becomes an index or offset into the internal
system bus memory space. This is accomplished with an initial
“address fetch” TD that reads the target address location from
the peripheral and writes that value into a subsequent TD in the
chain. This modifies the TD chain on the fly. When the “address
fetch” TD completes it moves on to the next TD, which has the
new address information embedded in it. This TD then carries
out the data transfer with the address location required by the
external master.
4.3.4.6 Scatter Gather DMA
In the case of scatter gather DMA, there are multiple
noncontiguous sources or destinations that are required to
effectively carry out an overall DMA transaction. For example, a
packet may need to be transmitted off of the device and the
packet elements, including the header, payload, and trailer, exist
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Basic DMA Write Transfer without wait states
in various noncontiguous locations in memory. Scatter gather
DMA allows the segments to be concatenated together by using
multiple TDs in a chain. The chain gathers the data from the
multiple locations. A similar concept applies for the reception of
data onto the device. Certain parts of the received data may need
to be scattered to various locations in memory for software
processing convenience. Each TD in the chain specifies the
location for each discrete element in the chain.
4.3.4.7 Packet Queuing DMA
Packet queuing DMA is similar to scatter gather DMA but
specifically refers to packet protocols. With these protocols,
there may be separate configuration, data, and status phases
associated with sending or receiving a packet.
For instance, to transmit a packet, a memory mapped
configuration register can be written inside a peripheral,
specifying the overall length of the ensuing data phase. The CPU
can set up this configuration information anywhere in system
memory and copy it with a simple TD to the peripheral. After the
configuration phase, a data phase TD (or a series of data phase
TDs) can begin (potentially using scatter gather). When the data
phase TD(s) finish, a status phase TD can be invoked that reads
some memory mapped status information from the peripheral
and copies it to a location in system memory specified by the
CPU for later inspection. Multiple sets of configuration, data, and
status phase “subchains” can be strung together to create larger
chains that transmit multiple packets in this way. A similar
concept exists in the opposite direction to receive the packets.
4.3.4.8 Nested DMA
One TD may modify another TD, as the TD configuration space
is memory mapped similar to any other peripheral. For example,
a first TD loads a second TD’s configuration and then calls the
second TD. The second TD moves data as required by the
application. When complete, the second TD calls the first TD,
which again updates the second TD’s configuration. This
process repeats as often as necessary.
Page 14 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
4.4 Interrupt Controller
The Cortex-M3 NVIC supports 16 system exceptions and 32 interrupts from peripherals, as shown in Table 4-5.
Table 4-5. Cortex-M3 Exceptions and Interrupts
Exception
Number
Exception Type
Priority
Exception Table
Address Offset
Function
0x00
Starting value of R13 / MSP
1
Reset
-3 (highest)
0x04
Reset
2
NMI
-2
0x08
Non maskable interrupt
3
Hard fault
-1
0x0C
All classes of fault, when the corresponding fault handler
cannot be activated because it is currently disabled or
masked
4
MemManage
Programmable
0x10
Memory management fault, for example, instruction
fetch from a nonexecutable region
5
Bus fault
Programmable
0x14
Error response received from the bus system; caused
by an instruction prefetch abort or data access error
6
Usage fault
Programmable
0x18
Typically caused by invalid instructions or trying to
switch to ARM mode
7 – 10
-
-
0x1C – 0x28
Reserved
11
SVC
Programmable
0x2C
System service call via SVC instruction
12
Debug monitor
Programmable
0x30
Debug monitor
13
-
-
0x34
Reserved
14
PendSV
Programmable
0x38
Deferred request for system service
15
SYSTICK
Programmable
0x3C
System tick timer
16 – 47
IRQ
Programmable
0x40 – 0x3FC
Peripheral interrupt request #0 - #31
Bit 0 of each exception vector indicates whether the exception is
executed using ARM or Thumb instructions. Because the
Cortex-M3 only supports Thumb instructions, this bit must
always be 1. The Cortex-M3 non maskable interrupt (NMI) input
can be routed to any pin, via the DSI, or disconnected from all
pins. See “DSI Routing Interface Description” section on
page 41.
The Nested Vectored Interrupt Controller (NVIC) handles
interrupts from the peripherals, and passes the interrupt vectors
to the CPU. It is closely integrated with the CPU for low latency
interrupt handling. Features include:
■
32 interrupts. Multiple sources for each interrupt.
■
Configurable number of priority levels: from 3 to 8.
■
Dynamic reprioritization of interrupts.
■
Priority grouping. This allows selection of preempting and non
preempting interrupt levels.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
■
Support for tail-chaining, and late arrival, of interrupts. This
enables back-to-back interrupt processing without the
overhead of state saving and restoration between interrupts.
■
Processor state automatically saved on interrupt entry, and
restored on interrupt exit, with no instruction overhead.
If the same priority level is assigned to two or more interrupts,
the interrupt with the lower vector number is executed first. Each
interrupt vector may choose from three interrupt sources: Fixed
Function, DMA, and UDB. The fixed function interrupts are direct
connections to the most common interrupt sources and provide
the lowest resource cost connection. The DMA interrupt sources
provide direct connections to the two DMA interrupt sources
provided per DMA channel. The third interrupt source for vectors
is from the UDB digital routing array. This allows any digital signal
available to the UDB array to be used as an interrupt source. All
interrupt sources may be routed to any interrupt vector using the
UDB interrupt source connections.
Page 15 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 4-6. Interrupt Vector Table
Interrupt #
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
Cortex-M3 Exception #
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Fixed Function
Low voltage detect (LVD)
Cache/ECC
Reserved
Sleep (Pwr Mgr)
PICU[0]
PICU[1]
PICU[2]
PICU[3]
PICU[4]
PICU[5]
PICU[6]
PICU[12]
PICU[15]
Comparators Combined
Switched Caps Combined
I2C
CAN
Timer/Counter0
Timer/Counter1
Timer/Counter2
Timer/Counter3
USB SOF Int
USB Arb Int
USB Bus Int
USB Endpoint[0]
USB Endpoint Data
Reserved
LCD
DFB Int
Decimator Int
phub_err_int
eeprom_fault_int
DMA
phub_termout0[0]
phub_termout0[1]
phub_termout0[2]
phub_termout0[3]
phub_termout0[4]
phub_termout0[5]
phub_termout0[6]
phub_termout0[7]
phub_termout0[8]
phub_termout0[9]
phub_termout0[10]
phub_termout0[11]
phub_termout0[12]
phub_termout0[13]
phub_termout0[14]
phub_termout0[15]
phub_termout1[0]
phub_termout1[1]
phub_termout1[2]
phub_termout1[3]
phub_termout1[4]
phub_termout1[5]
phub_termout1[6]
phub_termout1[7]
phub_termout1[8]
phub_termout1[9]
phub_termout1[10]
phub_termout1[11]
phub_termout1[12]
phub_termout1[13]
phub_termout1[14]
phub_termout1[15]
UDB
udb_intr[0]
udb_intr[1]
udb_intr[2]
udb_intr[3]
udb_intr[4]
udb_intr[5]
udb_intr[6]
udb_intr[7]
udb_intr[8]
udb_intr[9]
udb_intr[10]
udb_intr[11]
udb_intr[12]
udb_intr[13]
udb_intr[14]
udb_intr[15]
udb_intr[16]
udb_intr[17]
udb_intr[18]
udb_intr[19]
udb_intr[20]
udb_intr[21]
udb_intr[22]
udb_intr[23]
udb_intr[24]
udb_intr[25]
udb_intr[26]
udb_intr[27]
udb_intr[28]
udb_intr[29]
udb_intr[30]
udb_intr[31]
Page 16 of 122
PRELIMINARY
5. Memory
5.1 Static RAM
CY8C58LP static RAM (SRAM) is used for temporary data
storage. Code can be executed at full speed from the portion of
SRAM that is located in the code space. This process is slower
from SRAM above 0x20000000. The device provides up to 64
KB of SRAM. The CPU or the DMA controller can access all of
SRAM. The SRAM can be accessed simultaneously by the
Cortex-M3 CPU and the DMA controller if accessing different
32-KB blocks.
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Upgrade setting. Use the Unprotected setting only when no
security is needed in your application. The PSoC device also
offers an advanced security feature called Device Security which
permanently disables all test, programming, and debug ports,
protecting your application from external access (see the
“Device Security” section on page 60). For more information on
how to take full advantage of the security features in PSoC, see
the PSoC 5 TRM.
Table 5-1. Flash Protection
Protection
Setting
Allowed
Not Allowed
5.2 Flash Program Memory
Unprotected
Flash memory in PSoC devices provides nonvolatile storage for
user firmware, user configuration data, bulk data storage, and
optional ECC data. The main flash memory area contains up to
256 KB of user program space.
External read and write –
+ internal read and write
Factory
Upgrade
External write + internal
read and write
Up to an additional 32 KB of flash space is available for Error
Correcting Codes (ECC). If ECC is not used this space can store
device configuration data and bulk user data. User code may not
be run out of the ECC flash memory section. ECC can correct
one bit error and detect two bit errors per 8 bytes of firmware
memory; an interrupt can be generated when an error is
detected. The flash output is 9 bytes wide with 8 bytes of data
and 1 byte of ECC data.
The CPU or DMA controller read both user code and bulk data
located in flash through the cache controller. This provides
higher CPU performance. If ECC is enabled, the cache controller
also performs error checking and correction.
Flash programming is performed through a special interface and
preempts code execution out of flash. Code execution may be
done out of SRAM during flash programming.
The flash programming interface performs flash erasing,
programming and setting code protection levels. Flash in-system
serial programming (ISSP), typically used for production
programming, is possible through both the SWD and JTAG
interfaces. In-system programming, typically used for
bootloaders, is also possible using serial interfaces such as I2C,
USB, UART, and SPI, or any communications protocol.
5.3 Flash Security
All PSoC devices include a flexible flash protection model that
prevents access and visibility to on-chip flash memory. This
prevents duplication or reverse engineering of proprietary code.
Flash memory is organized in blocks, where each block contains
256 bytes of program or data and 32 bytes of ECC or
configuration data.
The device offers the ability to assign one of four protection
levels to each row of flash. Table 5-1 lists the protection modes
available. Flash protection levels can only be changed by
performing a complete flash erase. The Full Protection and Field
Upgrade settings disable external access (through a debugging
tool such as PSoC Creator, for example). If your application
requires code update through a boot loader, then use the Field
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
External read
Field Upgrade Internal read and write
External read and
write
Full Protection Internal read
External read and
write + internal write
Disclaimer
Note the following details of the flash code protection features on
Cypress devices.
Cypress products meet the specifications contained in their
particular Cypress datasheets. Cypress believes that its family of
products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the
market today, regardless of how they are used. There may be
methods, unknown to Cypress, that can breach the code
protection features. Any of these methods, to our knowledge,
would be dishonest and possibly illegal. Neither Cypress nor any
other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of
their code. Code protection does not mean that we are
guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.”
Cypress is willing to work with the customer who is concerned
about the integrity of their code. Code protection is constantly
evolving. We at Cypress are committed to continuously
improving the code protection features of our products.
5.4 EEPROM
PSoC EEPROM memory is a byte addressable nonvolatile
memory. The CY8C58LP has 2 KB of EEPROM memory to store
user data. Reads from EEPROM are random access at the byte
level. Reads are done directly; writes are done by sending write
commands to an EEPROM programming interface. CPU code
execution can continue from flash during EEPROM writes.
EEPROM is erasable and writeable at the row level. The
EEPROM is divided into 128 rows of 16 bytes each.
The CPU can not execute out of EEPROM. There is no ECC
hardware associated with EEPROM. If ECC is required it must
be handled in firmware.
Page 17 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
5.5 Nonvolatile Latches (NVLs)
PSoC has a 4-byte array of nonvolatile latches (NVLs) that are used to configure the device at reset. The NVL register map is shown
in Table 5-3..
Table 5-2. Device Configuration NVL Register Map
Register Address
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x00
PRT3RDM[1:0]
PRT2RDM[1:0]
PRT1RDM[1:0]
PRT0RDM[1:0]
0x01
PRT12RDM[1:0]
PRT6RDM[1:0]
PRT5RDM[1:0]
PRT4RDM[1:0]
0x02
XRESMEN
0x03
PRT15RDM[1:0]
DIG_PHS_DLY[3:0]
ECCEN
DPS[1:0]
CFGSPEED
The details for individual fields and their factory default settings are shown in Table 5-3:.
Table 5-3. Fields and Factory Default Settings
Field
Description
Settings
PRTxRDM[1:0]
Controls reset drive mode of the corresponding IO port. 00b (default) - high impedance analog
See “Reset Configuration” on page 35. All pins of the port 01b - high impedance digital
are set to the same mode.
10b - resistive pull up
11b - resistive pull down
XRESMEN
Controls whether pin P1[2] is used as a GPIO or as an
external reset. See “Pin Descriptions” on page 9, XRES
description.
0 (default) - GPIO
1 - external reset
CFGSPEED
Controls the speed of the IMO-based clock during the
device boot process, for faster boot or low-power
operation
0 (default) - 12 MHz IMO
1 - 48 MHz IMO
DPS{1:0]
Controls the usage of various P1 pins as a debug port.
See “Programming, Debug Interfaces, Resources” on
page 57.
00b - 5-wire JTAG
01b (default) - 4-wire JTAG
10b - SWD
11b - debug ports disabled
ECCEN
Controls whether ECC flash is used for ECC or for general 0 (default) - ECC disabled
configuration and data storage. See “Flash Program
1 - ECC enabled
Memory” on page 17.
DIG_PHS_DLY[3:0]
Selects the digital clock phase delay.
See the TRM for details.
Although PSoC Creator provides support for modifying the device configuration NVLs, the number of NVL erase/write cycles is limited
– see “Nonvolatile Latches (NVL)” on page 105.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 18 of 122
PRELIMINARY
5.6 External Memory Interface
CY8C58LP provides an external memory interface (EMIF) for
connecting to external memory devices. The connection allows
read and write accesses to external memories. The EMIF
operates in conjunction with UDBs, I/O ports, and other
hardware to generate external memory address and control
signals. At 33 MHz, each memory access cycle takes four bus
clock cycles.
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
External memory is located in the Cortex-M3 external RAM
space; it can use up to 24 address bits. See Memory Map on
page 20. The memory can be 8 or 16 bits wide. Cortex-M3
instructions can be fetched/executed from external memory,
although at a slower rate than from flash. There is no provision
for code security in external memory. If code must be kept
secure, then it should be placed in internal flash. See Flash
Security on page 17 and Device Security on page 60.
Figure 5-1 is the EMIF block diagram. The EMIF supports
synchronous and asynchronous memories. The CY8C58LP only
supports one type of external memory device at a time.
Figure 5-1. EMIF Block Diagram
Address Signals
External_ MEM_ ADDR[23:0]
I/O
PORTs
Data Signals
External_ MEM_ DATA[15:0]
I/O
PORTs
Control Signals
I/O
PORTs
Data,
Address,
and Control
Signals
IO IF
PHUB
Data,
Address,
and Control
Signals
Control
DSI Dynamic Output
Control
UDB
DSI to Port
Data,
Address,
and Control
Signals
EM Control
Signals
Other
Control
Signals
EMIF
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 19 of 122
PRELIMINARY
Table 5-5. Peripheral Data Address Map (continued)
5.7 Memory Map
The Cortex-M3 has a fixed address map, which allows
peripherals to be accessed by simple memory access
instructions.
5.7.1 Address Map
The 4-GB address space is divided into the ranges shown in
Table 5-4:
0x00000000 –
0x1FFFFFFF
0x20000000 –
0x3FFFFFFF
Address Range
Purpose
0x40004F00 – 0x40004FFF Fixed timer/counter/PWMs
0x40005000 – 0x400051FF I/O ports control
0x40005400 – 0x400054FF External Memory Interface
(EMIF) control registers
0x40005800 – 0x40005FFF Analog Subsystem Interface
0x40006000 – 0x400060FF USB Controller
Table 5-4. Address Map
Address Range
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
0x40006400 – 0x40006FFF UDB Configuration
Size
Use
0.5 GB
Program code. This includes
the exception vector table at
power up, which starts at
address 0.
0x40007000 – 0x40007FFF PHUB Configuration
Static RAM. This includes a 1
MByte bit-band region
starting at 0x20000000 and a
32 Mbyte bit-band alias
region starting at
0x22000000.
0x4000C000 – 0x4000C800 Digital Filter Block
0xE0000000 – 0xE00FFFFF Cortex-M3 PPB Registers,
including NVIC, debug, and trace
0.5 GB
0x40000000 –
0x5FFFFFFF
0.5 GB
Peripherals.
0x60000000 –
0x9FFFFFFF
1 GB
External RAM.
0xA0000000 –
0xDFFFFFFF
1 GB
External peripherals.
0xE0000000 –
0xFFFFFFFF
0.5 GB
Internal peripherals, including
the NVIC and debug and
trace modules.
0x40008000 – 0x400087FF EEPROM
0x4000A000 – 0x4000A400 CAN
0x40010000 – 0x4001FFFF Digital Interconnect Configuration
0x48000000 – 0x48007FFF Flash ECC Bytes
0x60000000 – 0x60FFFFFF External Memory Interface
(EMIF)
The bit-band feature allows individual bits in SRAM to be read or
written as atomic operations. This is done by reading or writing
bit 0 of corresponding words in the bit-band alias region. For
example, to set bit 3 in the word at address 0x20000000, write a
1 to address 0x2200000C. To test the value of that bit, read
address 0x2200000C and the result is either 0 or 1 depending
on the value of the bit.
0x00000000 – 0x0003FFFF 256 KB flash
Most memory accesses done by the Cortex-M3 are aligned, that
is, done on word (4-byte) boundary addresses. Unaligned
accesses of words and 16-bit half-words on nonword boundary
addresses can also be done, although they are less efficient.
0x1FFF8000 – 0x1FFFFFFF 32 KB SRAM in Code region
5.7.2 Address Map and Cortex-M3 Buses
0x20000000 – 0x20007FFF 32 KB SRAM in SRAM region
The ICode and DCode buses are used only for accesses within
the Code address range, 0 - 0x1FFFFFFF.
Table 5-5. Peripheral Data Address Map
Address Range
Purpose
0x40004000 – 0x400042FF Clocking, PLLs, and oscillators
0x40004300 – 0x400043FF Power management
0x40004500 – 0x400045FF Ports interrupt control
0x40004700 – 0x400047FF Flash programming interface
0x40004800 – 0x400048FF Cache controller
0x40004900 – 0x400049FF I2C controller
0x40004E00 – 0x40004EFF Decimator
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
The System bus is used for data accesses and debug accesses
within the ranges 0x20000000 - 0xDFFFFFFF and 0xE0100000
- 0xFFFFFFFF. Instruction fetches can also be done within the
range 0x20000000 - 0x3FFFFFFF, although these can be slower
than instruction fetches via the ICode bus.
The private peripheral bus (PPB) is used within the Cortex-M3 to
access system control registers and debug and trace module
registers.
Page 20 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
DSI signal from an external I/O pin or other logic
24- to 67-MHz fractional phase-locked loop (PLL) sourced
from IMO, MHzECO, or DSI
❐ 1-kHz, 33-kHz, 100-kHz ILO for watchdog timer (WDT) and
Sleep Timer
❐ 32.768-kHz external crystal oscillator (ECO) for RTC
6. System Integration
❐
❐
6.1 Clocking System
The clocking system generates, divides, and distributes clocks
throughout the PSoC system. For the majority of systems, no
external crystal is required. The IMO and PLL together can
generate up to a 67 MHz clock, accurate to ±1% over voltage and
temperature. Additional internal and external clock sources allow
each design to optimize accuracy, power, and cost. All of the
system clock sources can be used to generate other clock
frequencies in the 16-bit clock dividers and UDBs for anything
you want, for example a UART baud rate generator.
Clock generation and distribution is automatically configured
through the PSoC Creator IDE graphical interface. This is based
on the complete system’s requirements. It greatly speeds the
design process. PSoC Creator allows designers to build clocking
systems with minimal input. The designer can specify desired
clock frequencies and accuracies, and the software locates or
builds a clock that meets the required specifications. This is
possible because of the programmability inherent in PSoC.
■
IMO has a USB mode that auto-locks to the USB bus clock
requiring no external crystal for USB. (USB equipped parts
only)
■
Independently sourced clock in all clock dividers
■
Eight 16-bit clock dividers for the digital system
■
Four 16-bit clock dividers for the analog system
■
Dedicated 16-bit divider for the CPU bus and CPU clock
■
Automatic clock configuration in PSoC Creator
Key features of the clocking system include:
■
Seven general purpose clock sources
❐ 3- to 62-MHz IMO, ±1% at 3 MHz
❐ 4- to 25-MHz external crystal oscillator (MHzECO)
❐ Clock doubler provides a doubled clock frequency output for
the USB block, see USB Clock Domain on page 24.
Table 6-1. Oscillator Summary
Source
Fmin
Tolerance at Fmin
Fmax
Tolerance at Fmax
Startup Time
IMO
3 MHz
±1% over voltage and temperature
62 MHz
±7%
13 µs max
MHzECO
4 MHz
Crystal dependent
25 MHz
Crystal dependent
5 ms typ, max is
crystal dependent
DSI
0 MHz
Input dependent
66 MHz
Input dependent
Input dependent
PLL
24 MHz
Input dependent
67 MHz
Input dependent
250 µs max
Doubler
48 MHz
Input dependent
48 MHz
Input dependent
1 µs max
ILO
1 kHz
–50%, +100%
100 kHz
–55%, +100%
15 ms max in lowest
power mode
kHzECO
32 kHz
Crystal dependent
32 kHz
Crystal dependent
500 ms typ, max is
crystal dependent
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 21 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 6-1. Clocking Subsystem
3-62 MHz
IMO
4-25 MHz
ECO
External IO
or DSI
0-66 MHz
32 kHz ECO
1,33,100 kHz
ILO
CPU
Clock
48 MHz
Doubler for
USB
24-67 MHz
PLL
System
Clock Mux
Bus
Clock
Bus Clock Divider
16 bit
7
Digital Clock
Divider 16 bit
Digital Clock
Divider 16 bit
Analog Clock
Divider 16 bit
s
k
e
w
Digital Clock
Divider 16 bit
Digital Clock
Divider 16 bit
Analog Clock
Divider 16 bit
s
k
e
w
7
Digital Clock
Divider 16 bit
Digital Clock
Divider 16 bit
Analog Clock
Divider 16 bit
s
k
e
w
Digital Clock
Divider 16 bit
Digital Clock
Divider 16 bit
Analog Clock
Divider 16 bit
s
k
e
w
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 22 of 122
PRELIMINARY
6.1.1 Internal Oscillators
6.1.1.1 Internal Main Oscillator
In most designs the IMO is the only clock source required, due
to its ±1% accuracy. The IMO operates with no external
components and outputs a stable clock. A factory trim for each
frequency range is stored in the device. With the factory trim,
tolerance varies from ±1% at 3 MHz, up to ±7% at 62 MHz. The
IMO, in conjunction with the PLL, allows generation of CPU and
system clocks up to the device's maximum frequency (see USB
Clock Domain on page 24). The IMO provides clock outputs at
3, 6, 12, 24, 48, and 62 MHz.
6.1.1.2 Clock Doubler
The clock doubler outputs a clock at twice the frequency of the
input clock. The doubler works at input frequency of 24 MHz,
providing 48 MHz for the USB. It can be configured to use a clock
from the IMO, MHzECO, or the DSI (external pin).
6.1.1.3 Phase-Locked Loop
The PLL allows low frequency, high accuracy clocks to be
multiplied to higher frequencies. This is a tradeoff between
higher clock frequency and accuracy and, higher power
consumption and increased startup time.
The PLL block provides a mechanism for generating clock
frequencies based upon a variety of input sources. The PLL
outputs clock frequencies in the range of 24 to 67 MHz. Its input
and feedback dividers supply 4032 discrete ratios to create
almost any desired system clock frequency. The accuracy of the
PLL output depends on the accuracy of the PLL input source.
The most common PLL use is to multiply the IMO clock at 3 MHz,
where it is most accurate, to generate the CPU and system
clocks up to the device’s maximum frequency.
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
The central timewheel can be programmed to wake the system
periodically and optionally issue an interrupt. This enables
flexible, periodic wakeups from low power modes or coarse
timing applications. Systems that require accurate timing should
use the RTC capability instead of the central timewheel.
The 100-kHz clock (CLK100K) can be used as a low power
system clock to run the CPU. It can also generate time intervals
using the fast timewheel.
The fast timewheel is a 5-bit counter, clocked by the 100-kHz
clock. It features programmable settings and automatically
resets when the terminal count is reached. An optional interrupt
can be generated each time the terminal count is reached. This
enables flexible, periodic interrupts of the CPU at a higher rate
than is allowed using the central timewheel.
The 33-kHz clock (CLK33K) comes from a divide-by-3 operation
on CLK100K. This output can be used as a reduced accuracy
version of the 32.768-kHz ECO clock with no need for a crystal.
6.1.2 External Oscillators
6.1.2.1 MHz External Crystal Oscillator
The MHzECO provides high frequency, high precision clocking
using an external crystal (see Figure 6-2). It supports a wide
variety of crystal types, in the range of 4 to 25 MHz. When used
in conjunction with the PLL, it can generate CPU and system
clocks up to the device's maximum frequency (see
Phase-Locked Loop on page 23). The GPIO pins connecting to
the external crystal and capacitors are fixed. MHzECO accuracy
depends on the crystal chosen.
Figure 6-2. MHzECO Block Diagram
The PLL achieves phase lock within 250 µs (verified by bit
setting). It can be configured to use a clock from the IMO,
MHzECO, or DSI (external pin). The PLL clock source can be
used until lock is complete and signaled with a lock bit. The lock
signal can be routed through the DSI to generate an interrupt.
Disable the PLL before entering low power modes.
4 - 25 MHz
Crystal Osc
XCLK_MHZ
6.1.1.4 Internal Low-Speed Oscillator
The ILO provides clock frequencies for low power consumption,
including the watchdog timer, and sleep timer. The ILO
generates up to three different clocks: 1 kHz, 33 kHz, and
100 kHz.
The 1-kHz clock (CLK1K) is typically used for a background
‘heartbeat’ timer. This clock inherently lends itself to low power
supervisory operations such as the watchdog timer and long
sleep intervals using the central timewheel (CTW).
The central timewheel is a 1 kHz, free running, 13-bit counter
clocked by the ILO. The central timewheel is always enabled
except in hibernate mode and when the CPU is stopped during
debug on chip mode. It can be used to generate periodic
interrupts for timing purposes or to wake the system from a low
power mode. Firmware can reset the central timewheel.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Xi
(Pin P15[1])
External
Components
Xo
(Pin P15[0])
4 – 25 MHz
crystal
Capacitors
Page 23 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
6.1.2.2 32.768 kHz ECO
■
The 32.768-kHz external crystal oscillator (32kHzECO) provides
precision timing with minimal power consumption using an
external 32.768-kHz watch crystal (see Figure 6-3). The
32kHzECO also connects directly to the sleep timer and provides
the source for the RTC. The RTC uses a 1 second interrupt to
implement the RTC functionality in firmware.
The system clock is used to select and supply the fastest clock
in the system for general system clock requirements and clock
synchronization of the PSoC device.
■
Bus clock 16-bit divider uses the system clock to generate the
system’s bus clock used for data transfers and the CPU. The
CPU clock is directly derived from the bus clock.
■
Eight fully programmable 16-bit clock dividers generate digital
system clocks for general use in the digital system, as
configured by the design’s requirements. Digital system clocks
can generate custom clocks derived from any of the seven
clock sources for any purpose. Examples include baud rate
generators, accurate PWM periods, and timer clocks, and
many others. If more than eight digital clock dividers are
required, the UDBs and fixed function timer/counter/PWMs can
also generate clocks.
■
Four 16-bit clock dividers generate clocks for the analog system
components that require clocking, such as ADCs and mixers.
The analog clock dividers include skew control to ensure that
critical analog events do not occur simultaneously with digital
switching events. This is done to reduce analog system noise.
The oscillator works in two distinct power modes. This allows
users to trade off power consumption with noise immunity from
neighboring circuits. The GPIO pins connected to the external
crystal and capacitors are fixed.
Figure 6-3. 32kHzECO Block Diagram
XCLK32K
32 kHz
Crystal Osc
Xi
(Pin P15[3])
External
Components
Xo
(Pin P15[2])
32 kHz
crystal
Capacitors
Each clock divider consists of an 8-input multiplexer, a 16-bit
clock divider (divide by 2 and higher) that generates ~50% duty
cycle clocks, system clock resynchronization logic, and deglitch
logic. The outputs from each digital clock tree can be routed into
the digital system interconnect and then brought back into the
clock system as an input, allowing clock chaining of up to 32 bits.
6.1.4 USB Clock Domain
It is recommended that the external 32.768-kHz watch crystal
have a load capacitance (CL) of 6 pF or 12.5 pF. Check the
crystal manufacturer's datasheet. The two external capacitors,
CL1 and CL2, are typically of the same value, and their total
capacitance, CL1CL2 / (CL1 + CL2), including pin and trace
capacitance, should equal the crystal CL value. For more information, refer to application note AN54439: PSoC 3 and PSoC 5
External Oscillators. See also pin capacitance specifications in
the “GPIO” section on page 69.
6.1.2.3 Digital System Interconnect
The DSI provides routing for clocks taken from external clock
oscillators connected to I/O. The oscillators can also be
generated within the device in the digital system and UDBs.
While the primary DSI clock input provides access to all clocking
resources, up to eight other DSI clocks (internally or externally
generated) may be routed directly to the eight digital clock
dividers. This is only possible if there are multiple precision clock
sources.
The USB clock domain is unique in that it operates largely
asynchronously from the main clock network. The USB logic
contains a synchronous bus interface to the chip, while running
on an asynchronous clock to process USB data. The USB logic
requires a 48-MHz frequency. This frequency can be generated
from different sources, including DSI clock at 48 MHz or doubled
value of 24 MHz from internal oscillator, DSI signal, or crystal
oscillator.
6.2 Power System
The power system consists of separate analog, digital, and I/O
supply pins, labeled VDDA, VDDD, and VDDIOX, respectively. It
also includes two internal 1.8 V regulators that provide the digital
(VCCD) and analog (VCCA) supplies for the internal core logic.
The output pins of the regulators (VCCD and VCCA) and the
VDDIO pins must have capacitors connected as shown in
Figure 6-4. The two VCCD pins must be shorted together, with as
short a trace as possible, and connected to a 1 µF ±10% X5R
capacitor. The power system also contains a sleep regulator, an
I2C regulator, and a hibernate regulator.
6.1.3 Clock Distribution
All seven clock sources are inputs to the central clock distribution
system. The distribution system is designed to create multiple
high precision clocks. These clocks are customized for the
design’s requirements and eliminate the common problems
found with limited resolution prescalers attached to peripherals.
The clock distribution system generates several types of clock
trees.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 24 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
Figure 6-4. PSoC Power System
VDDD
1 µF
VDDIO2
VDDD
I/O Supply
VSSD
VCCD
VDDIO 2
VDDIO0
0.1 µF
0.1 µF
I/O Supply
VDDIO0
0.1 µF
I2C
Regulator
Sleep
Regulator
Digital
Domain
VDDA
VDDA
Analog
Regulator
Digital
Regulators
VSSB
VCCA
0.1 µF
1 µF
.
VSSA
Analog
Domain
0.1 µF
I/O Supply
VDDIO3
VDDD
VSSD
I/O Supply
VCCD
VDDIO1
Hibernate
Regulator
0.1 µF
0.1 µF
VDDIO1
VDDD
VDDIO3
Note The two VCCD pins must be connected together with as short a trace as possible. A trace under the device is recommended, as
shown in Figure 2-6.
You can power the device in internally regulated mode, where the voltage applied to the VDDx pins is as high as 5.5 V, and the internal
regulators provide the core voltages. In this mode, do not apply power to the VCCx pins, and do not tie the VDDx pins to the VCCx
pins.
You can also power the device in externally regulated mode, that is, by directly powering the VCCD and VCCA pins. In this configuration,
the VDDD pins should be shorted to the VCCD pins and the VDDA pin should be shorted to the VCCA pin. The allowed supply range in
this configuration is 1.71 V to 1.89 V. After power up in this configuration, the internal regulators are on by default, and should be
disabled to reduce power consumption.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 25 of 122
PRELIMINARY
Active is the main processing mode. Its functionality is
configurable. Each power controllable subsystem is enabled or
disabled by using separate power configuration template
registers. In alternate active mode, fewer subsystems are
enabled, reducing power. In sleep mode most resources are
disabled regardless of the template settings. Sleep mode is
optimized to provide timed sleep intervals and RTC functionality.
The lowest power mode is hibernate, which retains register and
SRAM state, but no clocks, and allows wakeup only from I/O
pins. Figure 6-5 illustrates the allowable transitions between
power modes. Sleep and hibernate modes should not be entered
until all VDDIO supplies are at valid voltage levels.
6.2.1 Power Modes
PSoC 5LP devices have four different power modes, as shown
in Table 6-2 and Table 6-3. The power modes allow a design to
easily provide required functionality and processing power while
simultaneously minimizing power consumption and maximizing
battery life in low power and portable devices.
PSoC 5LP power modes, in order of decreasing power
consumption are:
■
Active
■
Alternate active
■
Sleep
■
Hibernate
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 6-2. Power Modes
Power Modes
Description
Active
Primary mode of operation, all
peripherals available (programmable)
Alternate
Active
Sleep
Hibernate
Entry Condition Wakeup Source Active Clocks
Regulator
Wakeup, reset, Any interrupt
Any (programAll regulators available.
manual register
mable)
Digital and analog
entry
regulators can be disabled
if external regulation used.
Manual register Any interrupt
Any (programAll regulators available.
entry
mable)
Digital and analog
regulators can be disabled
if external regulation used.
Similar to Active mode, and is
typically configured to have
fewer peripherals active to
reduce power. One possible
configuration is to use the UDBs
for processing, with the CPU
turned off
All subsystems automatically
Manual register
disabled
entry
Manual register
All subsystems automatically
entry
disabled
Lowest power consuming mode
with all peripherals and internal
regulators disabled, except
hibernate regulator is enabled
Configuration and memory
contents retained
Comparator,
ILO/kHzECO
PICU, I2C, RTC,
CTW, LVD
PICU
Both digital and analog
regulators buzzed.
Digital and analog
regulators can be disabled
if external regulation used.
Only hibernate regulator
active.
Table 6-3. Power Modes Wakeup Time and Power Consumption
Sleep
Modes
Wakeup
Time
Current
(Typ)
Active
–
Alternate
Active
Sleep
Hibernate
Code
Execution
Digital
Resources
Analog
Resources
Clock Sources
Available
Wakeup Sources
Reset
Sources
3.1 mA[8]
Yes
All
All
All
–
All
–
–
User
defined
All
All
All
–
All
<25 µs
2 µA
No
I2C
Comparator
ILO/kHzECO
Comparator,
PICU, I2C, RTC,
CTW, LVD
XRES, LVD,
WDR
<125 µs
300 nA
No
None
None
None
PICU
XRES
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 26 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
on the input pins; no GPIO should toggle at a rate greater than
10 kHz while in hibernate mode. If pins must be toggled at a high
rate while in a low power mode, use sleep mode instead.
Figure 6-5. Power Mode Transitions
Active
6.2.1.5 Wakeup Events
Manual
Sleep
Hibernate
Alternate
Active
6.2.1.1 Active Mode
Active mode is the primary operating mode of the device. When
in active mode, the active configuration template bits control
which available resources are enabled or disabled. When a
resource is disabled, the digital clocks are gated, analog bias
currents are disabled, and leakage currents are reduced as
appropriate. User firmware can dynamically control subsystem
power by setting and clearing bits in the active configuration
template. The CPU can disable itself, in which case the CPU is
automatically reenabled at the next wakeup event.
When a wakeup event occurs, the global mode is always
returned to active, and the CPU is automatically enabled,
regardless of its template settings. Active mode is the default
global power mode upon boot.
6.2.1.2 Alternate Active Mode
Alternate Active mode is very similar to Active mode. In alternate
active mode, fewer subsystems are enabled, to reduce power
consumption. One possible configuration is to turn off the CPU
and flash, and run peripherals at full speed.
6.2.1.3 Sleep Mode
Sleep mode reduces power consumption when a resume time of
15 µs is acceptable. The wake time is used to ensure that the
regulator outputs are stable enough to directly enter active
mode.
Wakeup events are configurable and can come from an interrupt
or device reset. A wakeup event restores the system to active
mode. Firmware enabled interrupt sources include internally
generated interrupts, power supervisor, central timewheel, and
I/O interrupts. Internal interrupt sources can come from a variety
of peripherals, such as analog comparators and UDBs. The
central timewheel provides periodic interrupts to allow the
system to wake up, poll peripherals, or perform real-time
functions. Reset event sources include the external reset I/O pin
(XRES), WDT, and Precision Reset (PRES).
6.2.2 Boost Converter
Applications that use a supply voltage of less than 1.71 V, such
as single cell battery supplies, may use the on-chip boost
converter. The boost converter may also be used in any system
that requires a higher operating voltage than the supply provides.
For instance, this includes driving 5.0 V LCD glass in a 3.3 V
system. The boost converter accepts an input voltage as low as
0.5 V. With one low cost inductor it produces a selectable output
voltage sourcing enough current to operate the PSoC and other
on-board components.
The boost converter accepts an input voltage VBAT from 0.5 V
to 3.6 V, and can start up with VBAT as low as 0.5 V. The
converter provides a user configurable output voltage of 1.8 to
5.0 V (VBOOST). VBAT is typically less than VBOOST; if VBAT
is greater than or equal to VBOOST, then VBOOST will be the
same as VBAT. The block can deliver up to 75 mA (IBOOST)
depending on configuration.
Four pins are associated with the boost converter: VBAT, VSSB,
VBOOST, and Ind. The boosted output voltage is sensed at the
VBOOST pin and must be connected directly to the chip’s supply
inputs. An inductor is connected between the VBAT and Ind pins.
You can optimize the inductor value to increase the boost
converter efficiency based on input voltage, output voltage,
current and switching frequency.
Figure 6-6. Application for Boost Converter
VDDA
VBOOST
6.2.1.4 Hibernate Mode
In hibernate mode nearly all of the internal functions are
disabled. Internal voltages are reduced to the minimal level to
keep vital systems alive. Configuration state is preserved in
hibernate mode and SRAM memory is retained. GPIOs
configured as digital outputs maintain their previous values and
external GPIO pin interrupt settings are preserved. The device
can only return from hibernate mode in response to an external
I/O interrupt. The resume time from hibernate mode is less than
100 µs.
VDDD
Schottky diode
To achieve an extremely low current, the hibernate regulator has
limited capacity. This limits the frequency of any signal present
IND
PSoC
22 µF 0.1 µF
10 µH
22 µF
VBAT
VSSB
VSSA
VSSD
Note
8. Bus clock off. Execute from CPU instruction buffer at 6 MHz. See Table 11-2 on page 63.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 27 of 122
PRELIMINARY
The switching frequency is set to 400 kHz using an oscillator in
the boost converter block. The VBOOST is limited to 4 × VBAT.
Figure 6-7. Resets
VDDD VDDA
The boost converter can be operated in two different modes:
active and sleep. Active mode is the normal mode of operation
where the boost regulator actively generates a regulated output
voltage.
The boost typically draws 250 µA in active mode and 25 µA in
sleep mode. The boost operating modes must be used in
conjunction with chip power modes to minimize total power
consumption. Table 6-4 lists the boost power modes available in
different chip power modes.
Table 6-4. Chip and Boost Power Modes Compatibility
Chip Power Modes
Power
Voltage
Level
Monitors
Reset
Pin
External
Reset
Processor
Interrupt
Reset
Controller
System
Reset
Boost Power Modes
Chip -Active or
alternate active mode
Boost must be operated in its active
mode.
Chip -Sleep mode
Boost can be operated in either active
or sleep mode. In boost sleep mode,
the chip must wake up periodically for
boost active-mode refresh.
Chip-Hibernate mode
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Boost can be operated in either active
or sleep mode. However, it is
recommended not to use the boost with
chip hibernate mode due to the higher
current consumption. In boost sleep
mode, the chip must wake up
periodically for boost active-mode
refresh.
Watchdog
Timer
Software
Reset
Register
The term system reset indicates that the processor as well as
analog and digital peripherals and registers are reset.
If the boost converter is not used, tie the VBAT, VSSB, and
VBOOST pins to ground and leave the Ind pin unconnected.
A reset status register shows some of the resets or power voltage
monitoring interrupts. The program may examine this register to
detect and report certain exception conditions. This register is
cleared after a power-on reset. For details see the Technical
Reference Manual.
6.3 Reset
6.3.1 Reset Sources
CY8C58LP has multiple internal and external reset sources
available. The reset sources are:
■ Power source monitoring - The analog and digital power
voltages, VDDA, VDDD, VCCA, and VCCD are monitored in
several different modes during power up, active mode, and
sleep mode (buzzing). If any of the voltages goes outside
predetermined ranges then a reset is generated. The monitors
are programmable to generate an interrupt to the processor
under certain conditions before reaching the reset thresholds.
■ External - The device can be reset from an external source by
pulling the reset pin (XRES) low. The XRES pin includes an
internal pull-up to VDDIO1. VDDD, VDDA, and VDDIO1 must
all have voltage applied before the part comes out of reset.
■ Watchdog timer - A watchdog timer monitors the execution of
instructions by the processor. If the watchdog timer is not reset
by firmware within a certain period of time, the watchdog timer
generates a reset.
■ Software - The device can be reset under program control.
6.3.1.1 Power Voltage Level Monitors
■ IPOR - Initial Power-on-Reset
At initial power on, IPOR monitors the power voltages VDDD,
VDDA, VCCD and VCCA. The trip level is not precise. It is set to
approximately 1 volt, which is below the lowest specified
operating voltage but high enough for the internal circuits to be
reset and to hold their reset state. The monitor generates a
reset pulse that is at least 150 ns wide. It may be much wider
if one or more of the voltages ramps up slowly.
If after the IPOR triggers either VDDX drops back below the
trigger point, in a non-monotonic fashion, it must remain below
that point for at least 10 µs. The hysteresis of the IPOR trigger
point is typically 100 mV.
After boot, the IPOR circuit is disabled and voltage supervision
is handed off to the precise low-voltage reset (PRES) circuit.
■ PRES - Precise Low-Voltage Reset
This circuit monitors the outputs of the analog and digital
internal regulators after power up. The regulator outputs are
compared to a precise reference voltage. The response to a
PRES trip is identical to an IPOR reset.
In normal operating mode, the program cannot disable the
digital PRES circuit. The analog regulator can be disabled,
which also disables the analog portion of the PRES. The PRES
circuit is disabled automatically during sleep and hibernate
modes, with one exception: During sleep mode the regulators
are periodically activated (buzzed) to provide supervisory
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 28 of 122
PRELIMINARY
■
services and to reduce wakeup time. At these times the PRES
circuit is also buzzed to allow periodic voltage monitoring.
After PRES has been deasserted, at least 10 µs must elapse
before it can be reasserted.
ALVI, DLVI, AHVI - Analog/Digital Low Voltage Interrupt, Analog
High Voltage Interrupt
Interrupt circuits are available to detect when VDDA and
VDDD go outside a voltage range. For AHVI, VDDA is
compared to a fixed trip level. For ALVI and DLVI, VDDA and
VDDD are compared to trip levels that are programmable, as
listed in Table 6-5. ALVI and DLVI can also be configured to
generate a device reset instead of an interrupt.
Table 6-5. Analog/Digital Low Voltage Interrupt, Analog High
Voltage Interrupt
Interrupt
Supply
Normal Voltage
Range
Available Trip
Settings
DLVI
VDDD
1.71 V-5.5 V
1.70 V-5.45 V in
250 mV increments
ALVI
VDDA
1.71 V-5.5 V
1.70 V-5.45 V in
250 mV increments
AHVI
VDDA
1.71 V-5.5 V
5.75 V
The monitors are disabled until after IPOR. During sleep mode
these circuits are periodically activated (buzzed). If an interrupt
occurs during buzzing then the system first enters its wakeup
sequence. The interrupt is then recognized and may be
serviced.
The buzz frequency is adjustable, and should be set to be less
than the minimum time that any voltage is expected to be out
of range. For details on how to adjust the buzz frequency, see
the TRM.
■
Note IPOR disables the watchdog function. The program must
enable the watchdog function at an appropriate point in the
code by setting a register bit. When this bit is set, it cannot be
cleared again except by an IPOR power on reset event.
6.4 I/O System and Routing
PSoC I/Os are extremely flexible. Every GPIO has analog and
digital I/O capability. All I/Os have a large number of drive modes,
which are set at POR. PSoC also provides up to four individual
I/O voltage domains through the VDDIO pins.
There are two types of I/O pins on every device; those with USB
provide a third type. Both general purpose I/O (GPIO) and
special I/O (SIO) provide similar digital functionality. The primary
differences are their analog capability and drive strength.
Devices that include USB also provide two USBIO pins that
support specific USB functionality as well as limited GPIO
capability.
All I/O pins are available for use as digital inputs and outputs for
both the CPU and digital peripherals. In addition, all I/O pins can
generate an interrupt. The flexible and advanced capabilities of
the PSoC I/O, combined with any signal to any pin routability,
greatly simplify circuit design and board layout. All GPIO pins can
be used for analog input, CapSense[9], and LCD segment drive,
while SIO pins are used for voltages in excess of VDDA and for
programmable output voltages.
■
Features supported by both GPIO and SIO:
❐ User programmable port reset state
❐ Separate I/O supplies and voltages for up to four groups of I/O
❐ Digital peripherals use DSI to connect the pins
❐ Input or output or both for CPU and DMA
❐ Eight drive modes
❐ Every pin can be an interrupt source configured as rising
edge, falling edge or both edges. If required, level sensitive
interrupts are supported through the DSI
❐ Dedicated port interrupt vector for each port
❐ Slew rate controlled digital output drive mode
❐ Access port control and configuration registers on either port
basis or pin basis
❐ Separate port read (PS) and write (DR) data registers to avoid
read modify write errors
❐ Special functionality on a pin by pin basis
■
Additional features only provided on the GPIO pins:
❐ LCD segment drive on LCD equipped devices
[9]
❐ CapSense
❐ Analog input and output capability
❐ Continuous 100 µA clamp current capability
❐ Standard drive strength down to 1.71 V
XRES - External Reset
PSoC 5LP has either a single GPIO pin that is configured as
an external reset or a dedicated XRES pin. Either the
dedicated XRES pin or the GPIO pin, if configured, holds the
part in reset while held active (low). The response to an XRES
is the same as to an IPOR reset. The external reset is active
low. It includes an internal pull-up resistor. XRES is active
during sleep and hibernate modes.
After XRES has been deasserted, at least 10 µs must elapse
before it can be reasserted.
■
SRES - Software Reset
A reset can be commanded under program control by setting
a bit in the software reset register. This is done either directly
by the program or indirectly by DMA access. The response to
a SRES is the same as after an IPOR reset.
Another register bit exists to disable this function.
WRES - Watchdog Timer Reset
The watchdog reset detects when the software program is no
longer being executed correctly. To indicate to the watchdog
timer that it is running correctly, the program must periodically
reset the timer. If the timer is not reset before a user-specified
amount of time, then a reset is generated.
6.3.1.2 Other Reset Sources
■
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Note
9. GPIOs with opamp outputs are not recommended for use with CapSense.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 29 of 122
PRELIMINARY
■
Additional features only provided on SIO pins:
❐ Higher drive strength than GPIO
❐ Hot swap capability (5 V tolerance at any operating VDD)
❐ Programmable and regulated high input and output drive
levels down to 1.2 V
❐ No analog input, CapSense, or LCD capability
❐ Over voltage tolerance up to 5.5 V
❐ SIO can act as a general purpose analog comparator
■
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
USBIO features:
❐ Full speed USB 2.0 compliant I/O
❐ Highest drive strength for general purpose use
❐ Input, output, or both for CPU and DMA
❐ Input, output, or both for digital peripherals
❐ Digital output (CMOS) drive mode
❐ Each pin can be an interrupt source configured as rising
edge, falling edge, or both edges
Figure 6-8. GPIO Block Diagram
Digital Input Path
Naming Convention
‘x’ = Port Number
‘y’ = Pin Number
PRT[x]CTL
PRT[x]DBL_SYNC_IN
PRT[x]PS
Digital System Input
PICU[x]INTTYPE[y]
Input Buffer Disable
PICU[x]INTSTAT
Interrupt
Logic
Pin Interrupt Signal
PICU[x]INTSTAT
Digital Output Path
PRT[x]SLW
PRT[x]SYNC_OUT
Vddio Vddio
PRT[x]DR
0
Digital System Output
In
1
Vddio
PRT[x]BYP
Drive
Logic
PRT[x]DM2
PRT[x]DM1
PRT[x]DM0
Bidirectional Control
PRT[x]BIE
Analog
Slew
Cntl
PIN
OE
1
Capsense Global Control
0
1
0
1
CAPS[x]CFG1
Switches
PRT[x]AG
Analog Global
PRT[x]AMUX
Analog Mux
LCD
Display
Data
PRT[x]LCD_COM_SEG
Logic & MUX
PRT[x]LCD_EN
LCD Bias Bus
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
5
Page 30 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
Figure 6-9. SIO Input/Output Block Diagram
Digital Input Path
PRT[x]SIO_HYST_EN
PRT[x]SIO_DIFF
Reference Level
PRT[x]DBL_SYNC_IN
Naming Convention
‘x’ = Port Number
‘y’ = Pin Number
Buffer
Thresholds
PRT[x]PS
Digital System Input
PICU[x]INTTYPE[y]
Input Buffer Disable
PICU[x]INTSTAT
Interrupt
Logic
Pin Interrupt Signal
PICU[x]INTSTAT
Digital Output Path
Reference Level
PRT[x]SIO_CFG
PRT[x]SLW
PRT[x]SYNC_OUT
Driver
Vhigh
PRT[x]DR
0
Digital System Output
In
1
PRT[x]BYP
Drive
Logic
PRT[x]DM2
PRT[x]DM1
PRT[x]DM0
Bidirectional Control
PRT[x]BIE
Slew
Cntl
PIN
OE
Figure 6-10. USBIO Block Diagram
Digital Input Path
Naming Convention
‘y’ = Pin Number
USB Receiver Circuitry
PRT[15]DBL_SYNC_IN
PRT[15]PS[6,7]
USBIO_CR1[0,1]
Digital System Input
PICU[15]INTTYPE[y]
PICU[15]INTSTAT
Interrupt
Logic
Pin Interrupt Signal
PICU[15]INTSTAT
Digital Output Path
PRT[15]SYNC_OUT
USBIO_CR1[5]
USB or I/O
USBIO_CR1[2]
Vddd
USB SIE Control for USB Mode
PRT[15]DR1[7,6]
Digital System Output
PRT[15]BYP
1
In
Drive
Logic
D+ Open
Drain
PRT[15]DM0[7]
D- Open
Drain
PRT[15]DM1[7]
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
0
PRT[15]DM0[6]
PRT[15]DM1[6]
D+ pin only
D+ 1.5 k
Vddd
5k
Vddd Vddd
1.5 k
PIN
D+ 5 k
D- 5 k
Page 31 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
6.4.1 Drive Modes
Each GPIO and SIO pin is individually configurable into one of
the eight drive modes listed in Table 6-6. Three configuration bits
are used for each pin (DM[2:0]) and set in the PRTxDM[2:0]
registers. Figure 6-11 depicts a simplified pin view based on
each of the eight drive modes. Table 6-6 shows the I/O pin’s drive
state based on the port data register value or digital array signal
if bypass mode is selected. Note that the actual I/O pin voltage
is determined by a combination of the selected drive mode and
the load at the pin. For example, if a GPIO pin is configured for
resistive pull-up mode and driven high while the pin is floating,
the voltage measured at the pin is a high logic state. If the same
GPIO pin is externally tied to ground then the voltage
unmeasured at the pin is a low logic state.
Figure 6-11. Drive Mode
Vddio
DR
PS
0.
Pin
High Impedance
Analog
DR
PS
Pin
1. High Impedance
Digital
DR
PS
Pin
2. Resistive
Pull-Up
Vddio
DR
PS
Pin
4. Open Drain,
Drives Low
DR
PS
Vddio
DR
PS
3. Resistive
Pull-Down
Vddio
Pin
5. Open Drain,
Drives High
DR
PS
Vddio
Pin
6. Strong Drive
Pin
DR
PS
Pin
7. Resistive
Pull-Up and Pull-Down
Table 6-6. Drive Modes
Diagram
PRTxDM2
PRTxDM1
PRTxDM0
PRTxDR = 1
PRTxDR = 0
0
High impedence analog
Drive Mode
0
0
0
High-Z
High-Z
1
High Impedance digital
0
0
1
High-Z
High-Z
2
Resistive pull-up[10]
0
1
0
Res High (5K)
Strong Low
3
Resistive pull-down[10]
0
1
1
Strong High
Res Low (5K)
4
Open drain, drives low
1
0
0
High-Z
Strong Low
5
Open drain, drive high
1
0
1
Strong High
High-Z
6
Strong drive
1
1
0
Strong High
Strong Low
7
Resistive pull-up and pull-down[10]
1
1
1
Res High (5K)
Res Low (5K)
Note
10. Resistive pull-up and pull-down are not available with SIO in regulated output mode.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 32 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
The USBIO pins (P15[7] and P15[6]), when enabled for I/O mode, have limited drive mode control. The drive mode is set using the
PRT15.DM0[7, 6] register. A resistive pull option is also available at the USBIO pins, which can be enabled using the PRT15.DM1[7,
6] register. When enabled for USB mode, the drive mode control has no impact on the configuration of the USB pins. Unlike the GPIO
and SIO configurations, the port wide configuration registers do not configure the USB drive mode bits. Table 6-7 shows the drive
mode configuration for the USBIO pins.
Table 6-7. USBIO Drive Modes (P15[7] and P15[6])
■
■
■
■
■
■
PRT15.DM1[7,6]
Pull up enable
PRT15.DM0[7,6]
Drive Mode enable
PRT15.DR[7,6] = 1
PRT15.DR[7,6] = 0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
High Z
Strong High
Res High (5k)
Strong High
Strong Low
Strong Low
Strong Low
Strong Low
High impedance analog
Description
Open Drain, Strong Low
Strong Outputs
Resistive Pull Up, Strong Low
Strong Outputs
The default reset state with both the output driver and digital
input buffer turned off. This prevents any current from flowing
in the I/O’s digital input buffer due to a floating voltage. This
state is recommended for pins that are floating or that support
an analog voltage. High impedance analog pins do not provide
digital input functionality.
6.4.2 Pin Registers
Registers to configure and interact with pins come in two forms
that may be used interchangeably.
All I/O registers are available in the standard port form, where
each bit of the register corresponds to one of the port pins. This
register form is efficient for quickly reconfiguring multiple port
pins at the same time.
To achieve the lowest chip current in sleep modes, all I/Os
must either be configured to the high impedance analog mode,
or have their pins driven to a power supply rail by the PSoC
device or by external circuitry.
I/O registers are also available in pin form, which combines the
eight most commonly used port register bits into a single register
for each pin. This enables very fast configuration changes to
individual pins with a single register write.
High impedance digital
6.4.3 Bidirectional Mode
The input buffer is enabled for digital signal input. This is the
standard high impedance (HiZ) state recommended for digital
inputs.
Resistive pull-up or resistive pull-down
Resistive pull-up or pull-down, respectively, provides a series
resistance in one of the data states and strong drive in the
other. Pins can be used for digital input and output in these
modes. Interfacing to mechanical switches is a common
application for these modes. Resistive pull-up and pull-down
are not available with SIO in regulated output mode.
Open drain, drives high and open drain, drives low
Open drain modes provide high impedance in one of the data
states and strong drive in the other. Pins can be used for digital
input and output in these modes. A common application for
these modes is driving the I2C bus signal lines.
Strong drive
Provides a strong CMOS output drive in either high or low
state. This is the standard output mode for pins. Strong Drive
mode pins must not be used as inputs under normal
circumstances. This mode is often used to drive digital output
signals or external FETs.
Resistive pull-up and pull-down
Similar to the resistive pull-up and resistive pull-down modes
except the pin is always in series with a resistor. The high data
state is pull-up while the low data state is pull-down. This mode
is most often used when other signals that may cause shorts
can drive the bus. Resistive pull-up and pull-down are not
available with SIO in regulated output mode.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
High speed bidirectional capability allows pins to provide both
the high impedance digital drive mode for input signals and a
second user selected drive mode such as strong drive (set using
PRTxDM[2:0] registers) for output signals on the same pin,
based on the state of an auxiliary control bus signal. The
bidirectional capability is useful for processor busses and
communications interfaces such as the SPI Slave MISO pin that
requires dynamic hardware control of the output buffer.
The auxiliary control bus routes up to 16 UDB or digital peripheral
generated output enable signals to one or more pins.
6.4.4 Slew Rate Limited Mode
GPIO and SIO pins have fast and slow output slew rate options
for strong and open drain drive modes, not resistive drive modes.
Because it results in reduced EMI, the slow edge rate option is
recommended for signals that are not speed critical, generally
less than 1 MHz. The fast slew rate is for signals between 1 MHz
and 33 MHz. The slew rate is individually configurable for each
pin, and is set by the PRTxSLW registers.
6.4.5 Pin Interrupts
All GPIO and SIO pins are able to generate interrupts to the
system. All eight pins in each port interface to their own Port
Interrupt Control Unit (PICU) and associated interrupt vector.
Each pin of the port is independently configurable to detect rising
edge, falling edge, both edge interrupts, or to not generate an
interrupt.
Page 33 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
Depending on the configured mode for each pin, each time an
interrupt event occurs on a pin, its corresponding status bit of the
interrupt status register is set to “1” and an interrupt request is
sent to the interrupt controller. Each PICU has its own interrupt
vector in the interrupt controller and the pin status register
providing easy determination of the interrupt source down to the
pin level.
Port pin interrupts remain active in all sleep modes allowing the
PSoC device to wake from an externally generated interrupt.
While level sensitive interrupts are not directly supported;
Universal Digital Blocks (UDB) provide this functionality to the
system when needed.
6.4.6 Input Buffer Mode
GPIO and SIO input buffers can be configured at the port level
for the default CMOS input thresholds or the optional LVTTL
input thresholds. All input buffers incorporate Schmitt triggers for
input hysteresis. Additionally, individual pin input buffers can be
disabled in any drive mode.
6.4.7 I/O Power Supplies
Up to four I/O pin power supplies are provided depending on the
device and package. Each I/O supply must be less than or equal
to the voltage on the chip’s analog (VDDA) pin. This feature
allows users to provide different I/O voltage levels for different
pins on the device. Refer to the specific device package pinout
to determine VDDIO capability for a given port and pin. The SIO
port pins support an additional regulated high output capability,
as described in Adjustable Output Level.
6.4.8 Analog Connections
These connections apply only to GPIO pins. All GPIO pins may
be used as analog inputs or outputs. The analog voltage present
on the pin must not exceed the VDDIO supply voltage to which
the GPIO belongs. Each GPIO may connect to one of the analog
global busses or to one of the analog mux buses to connect any
pin to any internal analog resource such as ADC or comparators.
In addition, select pins provide direct connections to specific
analog features such as the high current DACs or uncommitted
opamps.
6.4.9 CapSense
This section applies only to GPIO pins. All GPIO pins may be
used to create CapSense buttons and sliders[11]. See the
“CapSense” section on page 55 for more information.
6.4.10 LCD Segment Drive
This section applies only to GPIO pins. All GPIO pins may be
used to generate Segment and Common drive signals for direct
glass drive of LCD glass. See the “LCD Direct Drive” section on
page 54 for details.
6.4.11 Adjustable Output Level
This section applies only to SIO pins. SIO port pins support the
ability to provide a regulated high output level for interface to
external signals that are lower in voltage than the SIO’s
respective VDDIO. SIO pins are individually configurable to
output either the standard VDDIO level or the regulated output,
which is based on an internally generated reference. Typically a
voltage DAC (VDAC) is used to generate the reference (see
Figure 6-12). The “DAC” section on page 55 has more details on
VDAC use and reference routing to the SIO pins. Resistive
pull-up and pull-down drive modes are not available with SIO in
regulated output mode.
6.4.12 Adjustable Input Level
This section applies only to SIO pins. SIO pins by default support
the standard CMOS and LVTTL input levels but also support a
differential mode with programmable levels. SIO pins are
grouped into pairs. Each pair shares a reference generator block
which, is used to set the digital input buffer reference level for
interface to external signals that differ in voltage from VDDIO.
The reference sets the pins voltage threshold for a high logic
level (see Figure 6-12). Available input thresholds are:
■ 0.5 × VDDIO
■ 0.4 × VDDIO
■ 0.5 × VREF
■ VREF
Typically a voltage DAC (VDAC) generates the VREF reference.
“DAC” section on page 55 has more details on VDAC use and
reference routing to the SIO pins.
Figure 6-12. SIO Reference for Input and Output
Input Path
Digital
Input
Vinref
Reference
Generator
SIO_Ref
PIN
Voutref
Output Path
Driver
Vhigh
Digital
Output
Drive
Logic
6.4.13 SIO as Comparator
This section applies only to SIO pins. The adjustable input level
feature of the SIOs as explained in the Adjustable Input Level
section can be used to construct a comparator. The threshold for
the comparator is provided by the SIO's reference generator. The
reference generator has the option to set the analog signal
routed through the analog global line as threshold for the
comparator. Note that a pair of SIO pins share the same
threshold.
Note
11. GPIOs with opamp outputs are not recommended for use with CapSense.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 34 of 122
PRELIMINARY
The digital input path in Figure 6-9 on page 31 illustrates this
functionality. In the figure, ‘Reference level’ is the analog signal
routed through the analog global. The hysteresis feature can
also be enabled for the input buffer of the SIO, which increases
noise immunity for the comparator.
6.4.14 Hot Swap
This section applies only to SIO pins. SIO pins support ‘hot swap’
capability to plug into an application without loading the signals
that are connected to the SIO pins even when no power is
applied to the PSoC device. This allows the unpowered PSoC to
maintain a high impedance load to the external device while also
preventing the PSoC from being powered through a SIO pin’s
protection diode.
Powering the device up or down while connected to an
operational I2C bus may cause transient states on the SIO pins.
The overall I2C bus design should take this into account.
6.4.15 Overvoltage Tolerance
All I/O pins provide an overvoltage tolerance feature at any
operating VDD.
■
There are no current limitations for the SIO pins as they present
a high impedance load to the external circuit.
■
The GPIO pins must be limited to 100 µA using a current limiting
resistor. GPIO pins clamp the pin voltage to approximately one
diode above the VDDIO supply.
■
In case of a GPIO pin configured for analog input/output, the
analog voltage on the pin must not exceed the VDDIO supply
voltage to which the GPIO belongs.
A common application for this feature is connection to a bus such
as I2C where different devices are running from different supply
voltages. In the I2C case, the PSoC chip is configured into the
Open Drain, Drives Low mode for the SIO pin. This allows an
external pull-up to pull the I2C bus voltage above the PSoC pin
supply. For example, the PSoC chip could operate at 1.8 V, and
an external device could run from 5 V. Note that the SIO pin’s
VIH and VIL levels are determined by the associated VDDIO
supply pin.
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
6.4.16 Reset Configuration
While reset is active all I/Os are reset to and held in the High
Impedance Analog state. After reset is released, the state can be
reprogrammed on a port-by-port basis to pull-down or pull-up. To
ensure correct reset operation, the port reset configuration data
is stored in special nonvolatile registers. The stored reset data is
automatically transferred to the port reset configuration registers
at reset release.
6.4.17 Low Power Functionality
In all low power modes the I/O pins retain their state until the part
is awakened and changed or reset. To awaken the part, use a
pin interrupt, because the port interrupt logic continues to
function in all low power modes.
6.4.18 Special Pin Functionality
Some pins on the device include additional special functionality
in addition to their GPIO or SIO functionality. The specific special
function pins are listed in “Pinouts” on page 5. The special
features are:
■
Digital
❐ 4- to 25-MHz crystal oscillator
❐ 32.768-kHz crystal oscillator
2
❐ Wake from sleep on I C address match. Any pin can be used
for I2C if wake from sleep is not required.
❐ JTAG interface pins
❐ SWD interface pins
❐ SWV interface pins
❐ TRACEPORT interface pins
❐ External reset
■
Analog
❐ Opamp inputs and outputs
❐ High current IDAC outputs
❐ External reference inputs
6.4.19 JTAG Boundary Scan
The device supports standard JTAG boundary scan chains on all
pins for board level test.
The SIO pin must be in one of the following modes: 0 (high
impedance analog), 1 (high impedance digital), or 4 (open drain
drives low). See Figure 6-11 for details. Absolute maximum
ratings for the device must be observed for all I/O pins.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 35 of 122
PRELIMINARY
7. Digital Subsystem
7.1 Example Peripherals
The digital programmable system creates application specific
combinations of both standard and advanced digital peripherals
and custom logic functions. These peripherals and logic are then
interconnected to each other and to any pin on the device,
providing a high level of design flexibility and IP security.
The features of the digital programmable system are outlined
here to provide an overview of capabilities and architecture. You
do not need to interact directly with the programmable digital
system at the hardware and register level. PSoC Creator
provides a high level schematic capture graphical interface to
automatically place and route resources similar to PLDs.
The main components of the digital programmable system are:
■
■
■
Universal Digital Blocks (UDB) - These form the core
functionality of the digital programmable system. UDBs are a
collection of uncommitted logic (PLD) and structural logic
(Datapath) optimized to create all common embedded
peripherals and customized functionality that are application or
design specific.
Universal Digital Block array - UDB blocks are arrayed within
a matrix of programmable interconnect. The UDB array
structure is homogeneous and allows for flexible mapping of
digital functions onto the array. The array supports extensive
and flexible routing interconnects between UDBs and the
Digital System Interconnect.
Digital System Interconnect (DSI) - Digital signals from
Universal Digital Blocks (UDBs), fixed function peripherals, I/O
pins, interrupts, DMA, and other system core signals are
attached to the Digital System Interconnect to implement full
featured device connectivity. The DSI allows any digital function
to any pin or other feature routability when used with the
Universal Digital Block array.
The flexibility of the CY8C58LP family’s UDBs and analog blocks
allow the user to create a wide range of components
(peripherals). The most common peripherals were built and
characterized by Cypress and are shown in the PSoC Creator
component catalog, however, users may also create their own
custom components using PSoC Creator. Using PSoC Creator,
users may also create their own components for reuse within
their organization, for example sensor interfaces, proprietary
algorithms, and display interfaces.
The number of components available through PSoC Creator is
too numerous to list in the datasheet, and the list is always
growing. An example of a component available for use in
CY8C58LP family, but, not explicitly called out in this datasheet
is the UART component.
7.1.1 Example Digital Components
The following is a sample of the digital components available in
PSoC Creator for the CY8C58LP family. The exact amount of
hardware resources (UDBs, routing, RAM, flash) used by a
component varies with the features selected in PSoC Creator for
the component.
■
Communications
2
❐I C
❐ UART
❐ SPI
■
Functions
❐ EMIF
❐ PWMs
❐ Timers
❐ Counters
■
Logic
❐ NOT
❐ OR
❐ XOR
❐ AND
Figure 7-1. CY8C58LP Digital Programmable Architecture
IO Port
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
IO Port
UDB Array
UDB Array
DSI Routing Interface
UDB
7.1.2 Example Analog Components
DSI Routing Interface
Digital Core System
and Fixed Function Peripherals
IO Port
IO Port
Digital Core System
and Fixed Function Peripherals
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
The following is a sample of the analog components available in
PSoC Creator for the CY8C58LP family. The exact amount of
hardware resources (SC/CT blocks, routing, RAM, flash) used
by a component varies with the features selected in PSoC
Creator for the component.
■
Amplifiers
❐ TIA
❐ PGA
❐ opamp
■
ADCs
❐ Delta-Sigma
❐ Successive Approximation (SAR)
■
DACs
❐ Current
❐ Voltage
❐ PWM
■
Comparators
■
Mixers
Page 36 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
7.1.3 Example System Function Components
7.1.4.2 Component Catalog
The following is a sample of the system function components
available in PSoC Creator for the CY8C58LP family. The exact
amount of hardware resources (UDBs, DFB taps, SC/CT blocks,
routing, RAM, flash) used by a component varies with the
features selected in PSoC Creator for the component.
The component catalog is a repository of reusable design
elements that select device functionality and customize your
PSoC device. It is populated with an impressive selection of
content; from simple primitives such as logic gates and device
registers, through the digital timers, counters and PWMs, plus
analog components such as ADCs, DACs, and filters, and
communication protocols, such as I2C, USB and CAN. See
“Example Peripherals” section on page 36 for more details about
available peripherals. All content is fully characterized and
carefully documented in datasheets with code examples, AC/DC
specifications, and user code ready APIs.
■
CapSense
■
LCD Drive
■
LCD Control
■
Filters
7.1.4 Designing with PSoC Creator
7.1.4.1 More Than a Typical IDE
A successful design tool allows for the rapid development and
deployment of both simple and complex designs. It reduces or
eliminates any learning curve. It makes the integration of a new
design into the production stream straightforward.
PSoC Creator is that design tool.
PSoC Creator is a full featured Integrated Development
Environment (IDE) for hardware and software design. It is
optimized specifically for PSoC devices and combines a modern,
powerful software development platform with a sophisticated
graphical design tool. This unique combination of tools makes
PSoC Creator the most flexible embedded design platform
available.
Graphical design entry simplifies the task of configuring a
particular part. You can select the required functionality from an
extensive catalog of components and place it in your design. All
components are parameterized and have an editor dialog that
allows you to tailor functionality to your needs.
PSoC Creator automatically configures clocks and routes the I/O
to the selected pins and then generates APIs to give the
application complete control over the hardware. Changing the
PSoC device configuration is as simple as adding a new
component, setting its parameters, and rebuilding the project.
At any stage of development you are free to change the
hardware configuration and even the target processor. To
retarget your application (hardware and software) to new
devices, even from 8- to 32-bit families, just select the new
device and rebuild.
You also have the ability to change the C compiler and evaluate
an alternative. Components are designed for portability and are
validated against all devices, from all families, and against all
supported tool chains. Switching compilers is as easy as editing
the from the project options and rebuilding the application with
no errors from the generated APIs or boot code.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
7.1.4.3 Design Reuse
The symbol editor gives you the ability to develop reusable
components that can significantly reduce future design time. Just
draw a symbol and associate that symbol with your proven
design. PSoC Creator allows for the placement of the new
symbol anywhere in the component catalog along with the
content provided by Cypress. You can then reuse your content
as many times as you want, and in any number of projects,
without ever having to revisit the details of the implementation.
7.1.4.4 Software Development
Anchoring the tool is a modern, highly customizable user
interface. It includes project management and integrated editors
for C and assembler source code, as well the design entry tools.
Project build control leverages compiler technology from top
commercial vendors such as ARM® Limited, Keil™, and
CodeSourcery (GNU). Free versions of Keil C51 and GNU C
Compiler (GCC) for ARM, with no restrictions on code size or end
product distribution, are included with the tool distribution.
Upgrading to more optimizing compilers is a snap with support
for the professional Keil C51 product and ARM RealView™
compiler.
7.1.4.5 Nonintrusive Debugging
With JTAG (4-wire) and SWD (2-wire) debug connectivity
available on all devices, the PSoC Creator debugger offers full
control over the target device with minimum intrusion.
Breakpoints and code execution commands are all readily
available from toolbar buttons and an impressive lineup of
windows—register, locals, watch, call stack, memory and
peripherals—make for an unparalleled level of visibility into the
system. PSoC Creator contains all the tools necessary to
complete a design, and then to maintain and extend that design
for years to come. All steps of the design flow are carefully
integrated and optimized for ease-of-use and to maximize
productivity.
Page 37 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 7-2. UDB Block Diagram
Clock
and Reset
Control
PT6
PT7
IN0
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
IN1
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
IN2
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
IN3
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
IN4
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
IN5
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
IN6
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
IN7
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
IN8
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
IN9
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
IN10
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
IN11
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
TC
PLD
12C4
(8 PTs)
OUT0
MC0
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
OUT1
MC1
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
OUT2
MC2
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
OUT3
MC3
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
T
SELOUT
(carry out)
Status and
Control
Datapath
Datapath
Chaining
Routing Channel
The main component blocks of the UDB are:
PLD blocks - There are two small PLDs per UDB. These blocks
take inputs from the routing array and form registered or
combinational sum-of-products logic. PLDs are used to
implement state machines, state bits, and combinational logic
equations. PLD configuration is automatically generated from
graphical primitives.
■ Datapath Module - This 8-bit wide datapath contains structured
logic to implement a dynamically configurable ALU, a variety
of compare configurations and condition generation. This block
also contains input/output FIFOs, which are the primary parallel
data interface between the CPU/DMA system and the UDB.
■ Status and Control Module - The primary role of this block is to
provide a way for CPU firmware to interact and synchronize
with UDB operation.
■ Clock and Reset Module - This block provides the UDB clocks
and reset selection and control.
■
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
AND
Array
SELIN
(carry in)
PLD
Chaining
PLD
12C4
(8 PTs)
PT5
Figure 7-3. PLD 12C4 Structure
PT4
To achieve this, UDBs consist of a combination of uncommitted
logic (PLD), structured logic (Datapath), and a flexible routing
scheme to provide interconnect between these elements, I/O
connections, and other peripherals. UDB functionality ranges
from simple self contained functions that are implemented in one
UDB, or even a portion of a UDB (unused resources are
available for other functions), to more complex functions that
require multiple UDBs. Examples of basic functions are timers,
counters, CRC generators, PWMs, dead band generators, and
communications functions, such as UARTs, SPI, and I2C. Also,
the PLD blocks and connectivity provide full featured general
purpose programmable logic within the limits of the available
resources.
PT3
The primary purpose of the PLD blocks is to implement logic
expressions, state machines, sequencers, look up tables, and
decoders. In the simplest use model, consider the PLD blocks as
a standalone resource onto which general purpose RTL is
synthesized and mapped. The more common and efficient use
model is to create digital functions from a combination of PLD
and datapath blocks, where the PLD implements only the
random logic and state portion of the function while the datapath
(ALU) implements the more structured elements.
PT2
The Universal Digital Block (UDB) represents an evolutionary
step to the next generation of PSoC embedded digital peripheral
functionality. The architecture in first generation PSoC digital
blocks provides coarse programmability in which a few fixed
functions with a small number of options are available. The new
UDB architecture is the optimal balance between configuration
granularity and efficient implementation. A cornerstone of this
approach is to provide the ability to customize the devices digital
operation to match application requirements.
PT1
7.2.1 PLD Module
PT0
7.2 Universal Digital Block
OR
Array
One 12C4 PLD block is shown in Figure 7-3. This PLD has 12
inputs, which feed across eight product terms. Each product term
(AND function) can be from 1 to 12 inputs wide, and in a given
product term, the true (T) or complement (C) of each input can
be selected. The product terms are summed (OR function) to
create the PLD outputs. A sum can be from 1 to 8 product terms
wide. The 'C' in 12C4 indicates that the width of the OR gate (in
this case 8) is constant across all outputs (rather than variable
as in a 22V10 device). This PLA like structure gives maximum
flexibility and insures that all inputs and outputs are permutable
for ease of allocation by the software tools. There are two 12C4
PLDs in each UDB.
7.2.2 Datapath Module
The datapath contains an 8-bit single cycle ALU, with associated
compare and condition generation logic. This datapath block is
optimized to implement embedded functions, such as timers,
counters, integrators, PWMs, PRS, CRC, shifters and dead band
generators, and many others.
Page 38 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 7-4. Datapath Top Level
PHUB System Bus
R/W Access to All
Registers
F1
F0
A0
A1
D0
D1
D1
Data Registers
D0
To/From
Previous
Datapath
A1
Conditions: 2 Compares,
2 Zero Detect, 2 Ones
Detect Overflow Detect
6
Datapath Control
Input from
Programmable
Routing
Control Store RAM
8 Word X 16 Bit
FIFOs
Input
Muxes
Chaining
Output
Muxes
6
Output to
Programmable
Routing
To/From
Next
Datapath
Accumulators
A0
PI
Parallel Input/Output
(To/From Programmable Routing)
PO
ALU
Shift
Mask
The datapath contains six primary working registers, which are
accessed by CPU firmware or DMA during normal operation.
sequence, and can be routed from any block connected to the
UDB routing matrix, most typically PLD logic, I/O pins, or from
the outputs of this or other datapath blocks.
Table 7-1. Working Datapath Registers
ALU
7.2.2.1 Working Registers
Name
Function
Description
The ALU performs eight general purpose functions. They are:
These are sources and sinks for
the ALU and also sources for the
compares.
■
Increment
■
Decrement
D0 and D1 Data Registers
These are sources for the ALU
and sources for the compares.
■
Add
■
Subtract
F0 and F1 FIFOs
These are the primary interface
to the system bus. They can be a
data source for the data registers
and accumulators or they can
capture data from the accumulators or ALU. Each FIFO is four
bytes deep.
■
Logical AND
■
Logical OR
■
Logical XOR
■
Pass, used to pass a value through the ALU to the shift register,
mask, or another UDB register
A0 and A1 Accumulators
7.2.2.2 Dynamic Datapath Configuration RAM
Dynamic configuration is the ability to change the datapath
function and internal configuration on a cycle-by-cycle basis,
under sequencer control. This is implemented using the 8-word
x 16-bit configuration RAM, which stores eight unique 16-bit wide
configurations. The address input to this RAM controls the
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Independent of the ALU operation, these functions are available:
■
Shift left
■
Shift right
■
Nibble swap
■
Bitwise OR mask
Page 39 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
7.2.2.3 Conditionals
7.2.2.7 Chaining
Each datapath has two compares, with bit masking options.
Compare operands include the two accumulators and the two
data registers in a variety of configurations. Other conditions
include zero detect, all ones detect, and overflow. These
conditions are the primary datapath outputs, a selection of which
can be driven out to the UDB routing matrix. Conditional
computation can use the built in chaining to neighboring UDBs
to operate on wider data widths without the need to use routing
resources.
The datapath can be configured to chain conditions and signals
such as carries and shift data with neighboring datapaths to
create higher precision arithmetic, shift, CRC/PRS functions.
7.2.2.4 Variable MSB
The most significant bit of an arithmetic and shift function can be
programmatically specified. This supports variable width CRC
and PRS functions, and in conjunction with ALU output masking,
can implement arbitrary width timers, counters and shift blocks.
7.2.2.5 Built-in CRC/PRS
The datapath has built in support for single cycle Cyclic
Redundancy Check (CRC) computation and Pseudo Random
Sequence (PRS) generation of arbitrary width and arbitrary
polynomial. CRC/PRS functions longer than 8 bits may be
implemented in conjunction with PLD logic, or built in chaining
may be use to extend the function into neighboring UDBs.
7.2.2.6 Input/Output FIFOs
Each datapath contains two four-byte deep FIFOs, which can be
independently configured as an input buffer (system bus writes
to the FIFO, datapath internal reads the FIFO), or an output
buffer (datapath internal writes to the FIFO, the system bus reads
from the FIFO). The FIFOs generate status that are selectable
as datapath outputs and can therefore be driven to the routing,
to interact with sequencers, interrupts, or DMA.
Figure 7-5. Example FIFO Configurations
System Bus
System Bus
F0
D0/D1
A0/A1/ALU
A0/A1/ALU
A0/A1/ALU
F1
F0
F1
System Bus
System Bus
TX/RX
Dual Capture
F0
F1
D0
A0
D1
A1
Dual Buffer
7.2.2.8 Time Multiplexing
In applications that are over sampled, or do not need high clock
rates, the single ALU block in the datapath can be efficiently
shared with two sets of registers and condition generators. Carry
and shift out data from the ALU are registered and can be
selected as inputs in subsequent cycles. This provides support
for 16-bit functions in one (8-bit) datapath.
7.2.2.9 Datapath I/O
There are six inputs and six outputs that connect the datapath to
the routing matrix. Inputs from the routing provide the
configuration for the datapath operation to perform in each cycle,
and the serial data inputs. Inputs can be routed from other UDB
blocks, other device peripherals, device I/O pins, and so on. The
outputs to the routing can be selected from the generated
conditions, and the serial data outputs. Outputs can be routed to
other UDB blocks, device peripherals, interrupt and DMA
controller, I/O pins, and so on.
7.2.3 Status and Control Module
The primary purpose of this circuitry is to coordinate CPU
firmware interaction with internal UDB operation.
Figure 7-6. Status and Control Registers
System Bus
8-bit Status Register
(Read Only)
8-bit Control Register
(Write/Read)
Routing Channel
The bits of the control register, which may be written to by the
system bus, are used to drive into the routing matrix, and thus
provide firmware with the opportunity to control the state of UDB
processing. The status register is read-only and it allows internal
UDB state to be read out onto the system bus directly from
internal routing. This allows firmware to monitor the state of UDB
processing. Each bit of these registers has programmable
connections to the routing matrix and routing connections are
made depending on the requirements of the application.
7.2.3.1 Usage Examples
As an example of control input, a bit in the control register can
be allocated as a function enable bit. There are multiple ways to
enable a function. In one method the control bit output would be
routed to the clock control block in one or more UDBs and serve
as a clock enable for the selected UDB blocks. A status example
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 40 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
Each subcomponent block of a UDB including the two PLDs, the
datapath, and Status and Control, has a clock selection and
control block. This promotes a fine granularity with respect to
allocating clocking resources to UDB component blocks and
allows unused UDB resources to be used by other functions for
maximum system efficiency.
7.3 UDB Array Description
Figure 7-7 shows an example of a 16 UDB array. In addition to
the array core, there are a DSI routing interfaces at the top and
bottom of the array. Other interfaces that are not explicitly shown
include the system interfaces for bus and clock distribution. The
UDB array includes multiple horizontal and vertical routing
channels each comprised of 96 wires. The wire connections to
UDBs, at horizontal/vertical intersection and at the DSI interface
are highly permutable providing efficient automatic routing in
PSoC Creator. Additionally the routing allows wire by wire
segmentation along the vertical and horizontal routing to further
increase routing flexibility and capability.
An example of this is the 8-bit Timer in the upper left corner of
the array. This function only requires one datapath in the UDB,
and therefore the PLD resources may be allocated to another
function. A function such as a Quadrature Decoder may require
more PLD logic than one UDB can supply and in this case can
utilize the unused PLD blocks in the 8-bit Timer UDB.
Programmable resources in the UDB array are generally
homogeneous so functions can be mapped to arbitrary
boundaries in the array.
Figure 7-8. Function Mapping Example in a Bank of UDBs
8-Bit
Timer
Sequencer
7.2.3.2 Clock Generation
Quadrature Decoder
UDB
UDB
HV
A
16-Bit PYRS
UDB
HV
B
UDB
HV
A
UDB
UDB
16-Bit
PWM
UDB
8-Bit
Timer Logic
UDB
8-Bit SPI
Figure 7-7. Digital System Interface Structure
I2C Slave
HV
B
12-Bit SPI
System Connections
UDB
HV
B
UDB
HV
A
UDB
HV
B
UDB
HV
A
HV
B
HV
B
UDB
HV
A
UDB
HV
A
UDB
HV
B
UART
UDB
UDB
UDB
UDB
HV
B
HV
A
Logic
UDB
HV
A
UDB
UDB
UDB
12-Bit PWM
UDB
7.4 DSI Routing Interface Description
UDB
UDB
HV
B
UDB
UDB
HV
A
UDB
HV
A
UDB
HV
B
UDB
HV
B
HV
A
UDB
HV
A
HV
B
The DSI routing interface is a continuation of the horizontal and
vertical routing channels at the top and bottom of the UDB array
core. It provides general purpose programmable routing
between device peripherals, including UDBs, I/Os, analog
peripherals, interrupts, DMA and fixed function peripherals.
Figure 7-9 illustrates the concept of the digital system
interconnect, which connects the UDB array routing matrix with
other device peripherals. Any digital core or fixed function
peripheral that needs programmable routing is connected to this
interface.
Signals in this category include:
System Connections
■
Interrupt requests from all digital peripherals in the system.
7.3.1 UDB Array Programmable Resources
■
DMA requests from all digital peripherals in the system.
Figure 7-8 shows an example of how functions are mapped into
a bank of 16 UDBs. The primary programmable resources of the
UDB are two PLDs, one datapath and one status/control register.
These resources are allocated independently, because they
have independently selectable clocks, and therefore unused
blocks are allocated to other unrelated functions.
■
Digital peripheral data signals that need flexible routing to I/Os.
■
Digital peripheral data signals that need connections to UDBs.
■
Connections to the interrupt and DMA controllers.
■
Connection to I/O pins.
■
Connection to analog system digital signals.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 41 of 122
PRELIMINARY
Figure 7-9. Digital System Interconnect
Timer
Counters
CAN
Interrupt
Controller
I2C
DMA
Controller
IO Port
Pins
Global
Clocks
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
single synchronized (pipelined) and a data input signal has the
option to be double synchronized. The synchronization clock is
the system clock (see Figure 6-1). Normally all inputs from pins
are synchronized as this is required if the CPU interacts with the
signal or any signal derived from it. Asynchronous inputs have
rare uses. An example of this is a feed through of combinational
PLD logic from input pins to output pins.
Figure 7-11. I/O Pin Synchronization Routing
Digital System Routing I/F
DO
UDB ARRAY
DI
Digital System Routing I/F
Figure 7-12. I/O Pin Output Connectivity
8 IO Data Output Connections from the
UDB Array Digital System Interface
Global
Clocks
IO Port
Pins
EMIF
DeltaSigma
ADC
SAR
ADC
SC/CT
Blocks
DACS
Comparators
Interrupt and DMA routing is very flexible in the CY8C58LP
programmable architecture. In addition to the numerous fixed
function peripherals that can generate interrupt requests, any
data signal in the UDB array routing can also be used to generate
a request. A single peripheral may generate multiple
independent interrupt requests simplifying system and firmware
design. Figure 7-10 shows the structure of the IDMUX
(Interrupt/DMA Multiplexer).
DO
PIN 0
DO
PIN1
DO
PIN2
DO
PIN3
DO
PIN4
DO
PIN5
DO
PIN6
DO
PIN7
Port i
Figure 7-10. Interrupt and DMA Processing in the IDMUX
Interrupt and DMA Processing in IDMUX
Fixed Function IRQs
0
1
IRQs
UDB Array
2
Edge
Detect
Interrupt
Controller
There are four more DSI connections to a given I/O port to
implement dynamic output enable control of pins. This
connectivity gives a range of options, from fully ganged 8-bits
controlled by one signal, to up to four individually controlled pins.
The output enable signal is useful for creating tri-state
bidirectional pins and buses.
Figure 7-13. I/O Pin Output Enable Connectivity
3
DRQs
DMA termout (IRQs)
4 IO Control Signal Connections from
UDB Array Digital System Interface
0
Fixed Function DRQs
1
Edge
Detect
DMA
Controller
2
7.4.1 I/O Port Routing
There are a total of 20 DSI routes to a typical 8-bit I/O port, 16
for data and four for drive strength control.
When an I/O pin is connected to the routing, there are two
primary connections available, an input and an output. In
conjunction with drive strength control, this can implement a
bidirectional I/O pin. A data output signal has the option to be
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
OE
PIN 0
OE
PIN1
OE
PIN2
OE
PIN3
OE
PIN4
OE
PIN5
OE
PIN6
OE
PIN7
Port i
Page 42 of 122
PRELIMINARY
7.5 CAN
The CAN peripheral is a fully functional Controller Area Network
(CAN) supporting communication baud rates up to 1 Mbps. The
CAN controller implements the CAN2.0A and CAN2.0B
specifications as defined in the Bosch specification and
conforms to the ISO-11898-1 standard. The CAN protocol was
originally designed for automotive applications with a focus on a
high level of fault detection. This ensures high communication
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
reliability at a low cost. Because of its success in automotive
applications, CAN is used as a standard communication protocol
for motion oriented machine control networks (CANOpen) and
factory automation applications (DeviceNet). The CAN controller
features allow the efficient implementation of higher level
protocols without affecting the performance of the
microcontroller CPU. Full configuration support is provided in
PSoC Creator.
Figure 7-14. CAN Bus System Implementation
CAN Node 1
CAN Node 2
CAN Node n
PSoC
CAN
Drivers
CAN Controller
En
Tx Rx
CAN Transceiver
CAN_H
CAN_L
CAN_H
CAN_L
CAN_H
CAN_L
CAN Bus
7.5.1 CAN Features
■
CAN2.0A/B protocol implementation - ISO 11898 compliant
❐ Standard and extended frames with up to 8 bytes of data per
frame
❐ Message filter capabilities
❐ Remote Transmission Request (RTR) support
❐ Programmable bit rate up to 1 Mbps
■
Listen Only mode
■
SW readable error counter and indicator
■
Sleep mode: Wake the device from sleep with activity on the
Rx pin
■
Supports two or three wire interface to external transceiver (Tx,
Rx, and Enable). The three-wire interface is compatible with
the Philips PHY; the PHY is not included on-chip. The three
wires can be routed to any I/O
■
Enhanced interrupt controller
❐ CAN receive and transmit buffers status
❐ CAN controller error status including BusOff
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
■
Receive path
❐ 16 receive buffers each with its own message filter
❐ Enhanced hardware message filter implementation that
covers the ID, IDE and RTR
❐ DeviceNet addressing support
❐ Multiple receive buffers linkable to build a larger receive
message array
❐ Automatic transmission request (RTR) response handler
❐ Lost received message notification
■
Transmit path
❐ Eight transmit buffers
❐ Programmable transmit priority
❐ Round robin
❐ Fixed priority
❐ Message transmissions abort capability
7.5.2 Software Tools Support
CAN Controller configuration integrated into PSoC Creator:
■
CAN Configuration walkthrough with bit timing analyzer
■
Receive filter setup
Page 43 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
Figure 7-15. CAN Controller Block Diagram
TxMessage0
TxReq
TxAbort
Tx Buffer
Status
TxReq
Pending
TxMessage1
TxReq
TxAbort
Bit Timing
Priority
Arbiter
TxMessage6
TxReq
TxAbort
TxInterrupt
Request
(if enabled)
TxMessage7
TxReq
TxAbort
RxInterrupt
Request
(if enabled)
RxMessage0
Acceptance Code 0
Acceptance Mask 0
RxMessage1
Acceptance Code 1
Acceptance Mask 1
RxMessage
Handler
RxMessage14
Acceptance Code 14
Acceptance Mask 14
RxMessage15
Acceptance Code 15
Acceptance Mask 15
ErrInterrupt
Request
(if enabled)
PSoC includes a dedicated Full-Speed (12 Mbps) USB 2.0
transceiver supporting all four USB transfer types: control,
interrupt, bulk, and isochronous. PSoC Creator provides full
configuration support. USB interfaces to hosts through two
dedicated USBIO pins, which are detailed in the “I/O System and
Routing” section on page 29.
USB includes the following features:
■
Eight unidirectional data endpoints
■
One bidirectional control endpoint 0 (EP0)
■
Shared 512-byte buffer for the eight data endpoints
■
Dedicated 8-byte buffer for EP0
■
Three memory modes
❐ Manual Memory Management with No DMA Access
❐ Manual Memory Management with Manual DMA Access
❐ Automatic Memory Management with Automatic DMA
Access
Internal 3.3 V regulator for transceiver
■
■
Internal 48 MHz oscillator that auto locks to USB bus clock,
requiring no external crystal for USB (USB equipped parts only)
■
Interrupts on bus and each endpoint event, with device wakeup
■
USB Reset, Suspend, and Resume operations
■
Bus powered and self powered modes
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Rx
CAN
Framer
Rx
CRC Check
WakeUp
Request
Error Detection
CRC
Form
ACK
Bit Stuffing
Bit Error
Overload
Arbitration
Figure 7-16. USB
Arbiter
System Bus
7.6 USB
Tx
CRC
Generator
Error Status
Error Active
Error Passive
Bus Off
Tx Error Counter
Rx Error Counter
RTR RxMessages
0-15
Rx Buffer
Status
RxMessage
Available
Tx
CAN
Framer
512 X 8
SRAM
D+
SIE
(Serial Interface
Engine)
External 22 Ω
Resistors
USB
I/O
Interrupts
D–
48 MHz
IMO
7.7 Timers, Counters, and PWMs
The Timer/Counter/PWM peripheral is a 16-bit dedicated
peripheral providing three of the most common embedded
peripheral features. As almost all embedded systems use some
combination of timers, counters, and PWMs. Four of them have
been included on this PSoC device family. Additional and more
advanced functionality timers, counters, and PWMs can also be
instantiated in Universal Digital Blocks (UDBs) as required.
PSoC Creator allows you to choose the timer, counter, and PWM
features that you need. The tool set utilizes the most optimal
resources available.
The Timer/Counter/PWM peripheral can select from multiple
clock sources, with input and output signals connected through
the DSI routing. DSI routing allows input and output connections
to any device pin and any internal digital signal accessible
Page 44 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
through the DSI. Each of the four instances has a compare
output, terminal count output (optional complementary compare
output), and programmable interrupt request line. The
Timer/Counter/PWMs are configurable as free running, one shot,
or Enable input controlled. The peripheral has timer reset and
capture inputs, and a kill input for control of the comparator
outputs. The peripheral supports full 16-bit capture.
Timer/Counter/PWM features include:
and generation of framing bits. I2C operates as a slave, a master,
or multimaster (Slave and Master). In slave mode, the unit
always listens for a start condition to begin sending or receiving
data. Master mode supplies the ability to generate the Start and
Stop conditions and initiate transactions. Multimaster mode
provides clock synchronization and arbitration to allow multiple
masters on the same bus. If Master mode is enabled and Slave
mode is not enabled, the block does not generate interrupts on
externally generated Start conditions. I2C interfaces through the
DSI routing and allows direct connections to any GPIO or SIO
pins.
■
16-bit timer/counter/PWM (down count only)
■
Selectable clock source
■
PWM comparator (configurable for LT, LTE, EQ, GTE, GT)
■
Period reload on start, reset, and terminal count
■
Interrupt on terminal count, compare true, or capture
I2C provides hardware address detect of a 7-bit address without
CPU intervention. Additionally the device can wake from low
power modes on a 7-bit hardware address match. If wakeup
functionality is required, I2C pin connections are limited to the
two special sets of SIO pins.
■
Dynamic counter reads
I2C features include:
■
Timer capture mode
■
Slave and master, transmitter, and receiver operation
■
Count while enable signal is asserted mode
■
Byte processing for low CPU overhead
■
Free run mode
■
Interrupt or polling CPU interface
■
One-shot mode (stop at end of period)
■
Support for bus speeds up to 1 Mbps
■
Complementary PWM outputs with deadband
■
■
PWM output kill
7 or 10-bit addressing (10-bit addressing requires firmware
support)
■
SMBus operation (through firmware support - SMBus
supported in hardware in UDBs)
■
7-bit hardware address compare
■
Wake from low power modes on address match
Figure 7-17. Timer/Counter/PWM
Clock
Reset
Enable
Capture
Kill
IRQ
TC / Compare!
Compare
Timer / Counter /
PWM 16-bit
Glitch filtering (active and alternate-active modes only)
Data transfers follow the format shown in Figure 7-18. After the
START condition (S), a slave address is sent. This address is 7
bits long followed by an eighth bit which is a data direction bit
(R/W) - a 'zero' indicates a transmission (WRITE), a 'one'
indicates a request for data (READ). A data transfer is always
terminated by a STOP condition (P) generated by the master.
However, if a master still wishes to communicate on the bus, it
can generate a repeated START condition (Sr) and address
another slave without first generating a STOP condition. Various
combinations of read/write formats are then possible within such
a transfer.
■
7.8 I2C
The I2C peripheral provides a synchronous two wire interface
designed to interface the PSoC device with a two wire I2C serial
communication bus. It is compatible[12] with I2C Standard-mode,
Fast-mode, and Fast-mode Plus devices as defined in the NXP
I2C-bus specification and user manual (UM10204). The I2C bus
I/O may be implemented with GPIO or SIO in open-drain modes.
Additional I2C interfaces can be instantiated using Universal
Digital Blocks (UDBs) in PSoC Creator, as required.
To eliminate the need for excessive CPU intervention and
overhead, I2C specific support is provided for status detection
Figure 7-18. I2C Complete Transfer Timing
SDA
1-7
SCL
START
Condition
ADDRESS
8
9
R/W
ACK
1-7
8
DATA
9
ACK
1-7
8
DATA
9
ACK
STOP
Condition
Note
12. The I2C peripheral is non-compliant with the NXP I2C specification in the following areas: analog glitch filter, I/O VOL/IOL, I/O hysteresis. The I2C Block has a digital
glitch filter (not available in sleep mode). The Fast-mode minimum fall-time specification can be met by setting the I/Os to slow speed mode. See the I/O Electrical
Specifications in “Inputs and Outputs” section on page 69 for details.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 45 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
7.9 Digital Filter Block
8. Analog Subsystem
Some devices in the CY8C58LP family of devices have a
dedicated HW accelerator block used for digital filtering. The
DFB has a dedicated multiplier and accumulator that calculates
a 24-bit by 24-bit multiply accumulate in one system clock cycle.
This enables the mapping of a direct form FIR filter that
approaches a computation rate of one FIR tap for each clock
cycle. The MCU can implement any of the functions performed
by this block, but at a slower rate that consumes significant MCU
bandwidth.
The analog programmable system creates application specific
combinations of both standard and advanced analog signal
processing blocks. These blocks are then interconnected to
each other and also to any pin on the device, providing a high
level of design flexibility and IP security. The features of the
analog subsystem are outlined here to provide an overview of
capabilities and architecture.
■
Flexible, configurable analog routing architecture provided by
analog globals, analog mux bus, and analog local buses
■
High resolution Delta-Sigma ADC
■
Two successive approximation (SAR) ADCs
■
Four 8-bit DACs that provide either voltage or current output
■
Four comparators with optional connection to configurable LUT
outputs
Data
Source
(PHUB)
■
Four configurable switched capacitor/continuos time (SC/CT)
blocks for functions that include opamp, unity gain buffer,
programmable gain amplifier, transimpedance amplifier, and
mixer
Data
Dest
(PHUB)
■
Four opamps for internal use and connection to GPIO that can
be used as high current output buffers
■
CapSense subsystem to enable capacitive touch sensing
■
Precision reference for generating an accurate analog voltage
for internal analog blocks
The PSoC Creator interface provides a wizard to implement FIR
and IIR digital filters with coefficients for LPF, BPF, HPF, Notch
and arbitrary shape filters. 64 pairs of data and coefficients are
stored. This enables a 64 tap FIR filter or up to 4 16 tap filters of
either FIR or IIR formulation.
Figure 7-19. DFB Application Diagram (pwr/gnd not shown)
BUSCLK
read_data
write_data
Digital
Routing
Digital Filter
Block
addr
System
Bus
DMA
Request
DMA
CTRL
The typical use model is for data to be supplied to the DFB over
the system bus from another on-chip system data source such
as an ADC. The data typically passes through main memory or
is directly transferred from another chip resource through DMA.
The DFB processes this data and passes the result to another
on chip resource such as a DAC or main memory through DMA
on the system bus.
Data movement in or out of the DFB is typically controlled by the
system DMA controller but can be moved directly by the MCU.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 46 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 8-1. Analog Subsystem Block Diagram
SAR
ADC
DAC
DAC
DelSig
ADC
A
N
A
L
O
G
SAR
ADC
Precision
Reference
DAC
DAC
SC/CT Block
SC/CT Block
Op
Amp
Op
Amp
SC/CT Block
Comparators
CMP
CMP
CMP
Op
Amp
R
O
U
T
I
N
G
Op
Amp
SC/CT Block
GPIO
Port
A
N
A
L
O
G
R
O
U
T
I
N
G
GPIO
Port
CMP
CapSense Subsystem
Analog
Interface
DSI
Array
Clock
Distribution
Config &
Status
Registers
PHUB
CPU
Decimator
The PSoC Creator software program provides a user friendly interface to configure the analog connections between the GPIO and
various analog resources and also connections from one analog resource to another. PSoC Creator also provides component libraries
that allow you to configure the various analog blocks to perform application specific functions (PGA, transimpedance amplifier, voltage
DAC, current DAC, and so on). The tool also generates API interface libraries that allow you to write firmware that allows the
communication between the analog peripheral and CPU/Memory.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 47 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
8.1 Analog Routing
8.1.2 Functional Description
The PSoC 5LP family of devices has a flexible analog routing
architecture that provides the capability to connect GPIOs and
different analog blocks, and also route signals between different
analog blocks. One of the strong points of this flexible routing
architecture is that it allows dynamic routing of input and output
connections to the different analog blocks.
Analog globals (AGs) and analog mux buses (AMUXBUS)
provide analog connectivity between GPIOs and the various
analog blocks. There are 16 AGs in the PSoC 5LP family. The
analog routing architecture is divided into four quadrants as
shown in Figure 8-2. Each quadrant has four analog globals
(AGL[0..3], AGL[4..7], AGR[0..3], AGR[4..7]). Each GPIO is
connected to the corresponding AG through an analog switch.
The analog mux bus is a shared routing resource that connects
to every GPIO through an analog switch. There are two
AMUXBUS routes in PSoC 5LP, one in the left half (AMUXBUSL)
and one in the right half (AMUXBUSR), as shown in Figure 8-2.
For information on how to make pin selections for optimal analog
routing, refer to the application note, AN58304 - PSoC® 3 and
PSoC® 5 - Pin Selection for Analog Designs.
8.1.1 Features
■
Flexible, configurable analog routing architecture
■
16 analog globals (AG) and two analog mux buses
(AMUXBUS) to connect GPIOs and the analog blocks
■
Each GPIO is connected to one analog global and one analog
mux bus
■
Eight analog local buses (abus) to route signals between the
different analog blocks
■
Multiplexers and switches for input and output selection of the
analog blocks
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Analog local buses (abus) are routing resources located within
the analog subsystem and are used to route signals between
different analog blocks. There are eight abus routes in PSoC
5LP, four in the left half (abusl [0:3]) and four in the right half
(abusr [0:3]) as shown in Figure 8-2. Using the abus saves the
analog globals and analog mux buses from being used for
interconnecting the analog blocks.
Multiplexers and switches exist on the various buses to direct
signals into and out of the analog blocks. A multiplexer can have
only one connection on at a time, whereas a switch can have
multiple connections on simultaneously. In Figure 8-2,
multiplexers are indicated by grayed ovals and switches are
indicated by transparent ovals.
Page 48 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
Figure 8-2. CY8C58LP Analog Interconnect
Vssd
*
*
*
*
*
swinn
*
AGL[6]
AGL[7]
*
swfol
swfol
swfol
GPIO
P3[5]
GPIO
swinp P3[4]
GPIO
swinn P3[3]
GPIO
P3[2]
GPIO
P3[1]
GPIO
P3[0]
GPXT
*P15[1]
GPXT
*P15[0]
opamp1
opamp3
3210 76543210
swfol
swinn
*
refbufl_
cmp
vref_cmp1
(0.256V)
comp1 +
-
COMPARATOR
+
- comp2
cmp_muxvn[1:0]
abuf_vref_int
(1.024V)
swin
comp3
+
-
refbufr
out
ref
in
refbuf_vref1 (1.024V)
refbuf_vref2 (1.2V)
refsel[1:0]
refsel[1:0]
sc0
Vin
Vref
out
vssa
sc0_bgref
(1.024V)
sc2_bgref
(1.024V)
Vin
Vref
out
sc2
sc1_bgref
(1.024V)
sc3_bgref
(1.024V)
Vin
Vref
out
sc3
v0
DAC0
i0
DAC1
v1
i1
v2
DAC2
i2
DAC3
v3
i3
VIDAC
+
DSM0
-
vssa
USB IO
* P15[6]
GPIO
P5[7]
GPIO
P5[6]
GPIO
P5[5]
GPIO
P5[4]
SIO
P12[7]
SIO
P12[6]
GPIO
*P1[7]
GPIO
*P1[6]
ExVrefL
refmux[2:0]
Vp (+)
Vn (-) SAR0
Vrefhi_out
refs
SAR_vref1 (1.024V)
SAR_vref2 (1.2V)
ExVrefR
(+) Vp
SAR1 (-) Vn
Vrefhi_out
refs
SAR_vref1 (1.024V)
SAR_vref2 (1.2V)
SAR ADC
Vdda
Vdda/2
ExVrefL1
Vdda
Vdda/2
ExVrefL2
01 23456 7 0123
3210 76543210
LPF
AGL[3]
AGL[2]
*
*
*
Vbat
Vssd
Ind
Vssb
Vboost
*
*
*
Large ( ~200 Ohms)
*
Switch Resistance
Small ( ~870 Ohms )
GPIO
P5[0]
GPIO
P5[1]
GPIO
P5[2]
GPIO
P5[3]
GPIO
P1[0]
GPIO
P1[1]
GPIO
P1[2]
GPIO
P1[3]
GPIO
P1[4]
GPIO
P1[5]
GPIO
P2[5]
GPIO
P2[6]
GPIO
P2[7]
SIO
P12[4]
SIO
P12[5]
GPIO
P6[4]
GPIO
P6[5]
GPIO
P6[6]
GPIO
P6[7]
*
*
Connection
*
Mux Group
Switch Group
XRES
*
AGL[1]
AGL[0]
AMUXBUSL
AGR[3]
AGR[2]
AGR[1]
AGR[0]
AMUXBUSR
Notes:
* Denotes pins on all packages
LCD signals are not shown.
AGR[0]
AMUXBUSR
VBE
Vss ref
Vddio1
AGR[3]
AGR[2]
AGR[1]
TS
ADC
AMUXBUSR
ANALOG ANALOG
BUS
GLOBALS
*
AGL[1]
AGL[2]
AGL[3]
AMUXBUSL
AGL[0]
ANALOG ANALOG
GLOBALS
BUS
*
AMUXBUSL
:
en_resvda
refmux[2:0]
refmux[2:0]
*
en_resvda
DSM
vcm
refs
qtz_ref
vref_vss_ext
dsm0_qtz_vref2 (1.2V)
dsm0_qtz_vref1 (1.024V)
Vdda/3
Vdda/4
Vddd
USB IO
*
vssd
dsm0_vcm_vref1 (0.8V)
dsm0_vcm_vref2 (0.7V)
Vssd
* P15[7]
dac_vref (0.256V)
vcmsel[1:0]
Vccd
ABUSR0
ABUSR1
ABUSR2
ABUSR3
ABUSL0
ABUSL1
ABUSL2
ABUSL3
*
*
Vddio2
SC/CT
Vssa
*
*
Vddd
sc1
Vin
Vref
out
AGR[4]
AMUXBUSR
CAPSENSE
out
ref
in refbufl
refbuf_vref1 (1.024V)
refbuf_vref2 (1.2V)
GPIO
P6[0]
GPIO
P6[1]
GPIO
P6[2]
GPIO
P6[3]
GPIO
P15[4]
GPIO
P15[5]
GPIO
P2[0]
GPIO
P2[1]
GPIO
P2[2]
GPIO
P2[3] *
GPIO
P2[4] *
i1
bg_vda_swabusl0
Vdda
Vdda/2
Vssd
i3
cmp0_vref
(1.024V)
cmp1_vref
bg_vda_res_en
Vccd
ExVrefR
AGR[7]
AGR[6]
AGR[5]
GPIO
P4[2]
GPIO
P4[3]
GPIO
P4[4]
GPIO
P4[5]
GPIO
P4[6]
GPIO
P4[7]
cmp1_vref
cmp0_vref
(1.024V)
comp0
+
-
swout
in1
out1
out0
swin
i2
*
LPF
in0
abuf_vref_int
(1.024V)
refbufr_
cmp
swout
i0
cmp1_vref
*
*
*
AGL[4]
AGL[5]
swinp
01 2 3 4 56 7 0123
*
opamp2
*
*
*
AMUXBUSL
*
AGR[5]
AGR[6]
AGR[7]
ExVrefL2
opamp0
swinp
GPIO
P0[4]
GPIO
P0[5]
GPIO
P0[6]
GPIO
P0[7]
*
AGR[4]
AGL[5]
AGL[6]
AGL[7]
ExVrefL
ExVrefL1
*
*
AMUXBUSR
AMUXBUSL
AGL[4]
Vddio3
GPIO
P3[6]
GPIO
P3[7]
SIO
P12[0]
SIO
P12[1]
GPIO
P15[2]
GPIO
P15[3]
swinp
*
Vcca
Vssa
Vdda
SIO
P12[2]
SIO
P12[3]
GPIO
P4[0]
GPIO
P4[1]
GPIO
P0[0]
GPIO
P0[1]
GPIO
P0[2]
GPIO
P0[3]
Vddio0
swinn
Rev #60
10-Feb-2012
To preserve detail of this figure, this figure is best viewed with a PDF display program or printed on a 11” × 17” paper.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 49 of 122
PRELIMINARY
8.2 Delta-sigma ADC
Figure 8-4. Delta-sigma ADC Block Diagram
The CY8C58LP device contains one delta-sigma ADC. This
ADC offers differential input, high resolution and excellent
linearity, making it a good ADC choice for both audio signal
processing and measurement applications. The converter's
nominal operation is 16 bits at 48 ksps. The ADC can be
configured to output 20-bit resolution at data rates of up to 187
sps. At a fixed clock rate, resolution can be traded for faster data
rates as shown in Table 8-1 and Figure 8-3.
Table 8-1. Delta-sigma ADC Performance
Maximum Sample Rate
(sps)
Bits
Positive
Input Mux
(Analog Routing)
Input
Buffer
Negative
Input Mux
Delta
Sigma
Modulator
Decimator
12 to 20 Bit
Result
EOC
SOC
Resolution and sample rate are controlled by the Decimator.
Data is pipelined in the decimator; the output is a function of the
last four samples. When the input multiplexer is switched, the
output data is not valid until after the fourth sample after the
switch.
SINAD (dB)
20
187
–
16
48 k
84
12
192 k
66
8.2.2 Operational Modes
8
384 k
43
The ADC can be configured by the user to operate in one of four
modes: Single Sample, Multi Sample, Continuous, or Multi
Sample (Turbo). All four modes are started by either a write to
the start bit in a control register or an assertion of the Start of
Conversion (SoC) signal. When the conversion is complete, a
status bit is set and the output signal End of Conversion (EoC)
asserts high and remains high until the value is read by either the
DMA controller or the CPU.
Figure 8-3. Delta-sigma ADC Sample Rates, Range = ±1.024 V
1000000
100000
Sample
e Rate, sps
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
8.2.2.1 Single Sample
10000
1000
100
10
1
6
8
10
12
14
16
18
20
22
Resolution, bits
Continuous
Multi-Sample
Multi-SampleTurbo
In Single Sample mode, the ADC performs one sample
conversion on a trigger. In this mode, the ADC stays in standby
state waiting for the SoC signal to be asserted. When SoC is
signaled the ADC performs four successive conversions. The
first three conversions prime the decimator. The ADC result is
valid and available after the fourth conversion, at which time the
EoC signal is generated. To detect the end of conversion, the
system may poll a control register for status or configure the
external EoC signal to generate an interrupt or invoke a DMA
request. When the transfer is done the ADC reenters the standby
state where it stays until another SoC event.
8.2.2.2 Continuous
8.2.1 Functional Description
The ADC connects and configures three basic components,
input buffer, delta-sigma modulator, and decimator. The basic
block diagram is shown in Figure 8-4. The signal from the input
muxes is delivered to the delta-sigma modulator either directly or
through the input buffer. The delta-sigma modulator performs the
actual analog to digital conversion. The modulator over-samples
the input and generates a serial data stream output. This high
speed data stream is not useful for most applications without
some type of post processing, and so is passed to the decimator
through the Analog Interface block. The decimator converts the
high speed serial data stream into parallel ADC results. The
modulator/decimator frequency response is [(sin x)/x]4.
Continuous sample mode is used to take multiple successive
samples of a single input signal. Multiplexing multiple inputs
should not be done with this mode. There is a latency of three
conversion times before the first conversion result is available.
This is the time required to prime the decimator. After the first
result, successive conversions are available at the selected
sample rate.
8.2.2.3 Multi Sample
Multi sample mode is similar to continuous mode except that the
ADC is reset between samples. This mode is useful when the
input is switched between multiple signals. The decimator is
re-primed between each sample so that previous samples do not
affect the current conversion. Upon completion of a sample, the
next sample is automatically initiated. The results can be
transferred using either firmware polling, interrupt, or DMA.
8.2.2.4 Multi Sample (Turbo)
The multi sample (turbo) mode operates identical to the
Multi-sample mode for resolutions of 8 to 16 bits. For resolutions
of 17 to 20 bits, the performance is about four times faster than
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 50 of 122
PRELIMINARY
the multi sample mode, because the ADC is only reset once at
the end of conversion.
More information on output formats is provided in the Technical
Reference Manual.
8.2.3 Start of Conversion Input
The SoC signal is used to start an ADC conversion. A digital
clock or UDB output can be used to drive this input. It can be
used when the sampling period must be longer than the ADC
conversion time or when the ADC must be synchronized to other
hardware. This signal is optional and does not need to be
connected if ADC is running in a continuous mode.
8.2.4 End of Conversion Output
The EoC signal goes high at the end of each ADC conversion.
This signal may be used to trigger either an interrupt or DMA
request.
8.3 Successive Approximation ADC
The CY8C58LP family of devices has two Successive
Approximation (SAR) ADCs. These ADCs are 12-bit at up to 1
Msps, with single-ended or differential inputs, making them
useful for a wide variety of sampling and control applications.
8.3.1 Functional Description
In a SAR ADC an analog input signal is sampled and compared
with the output of a DAC. A binary search algorithm is applied to
the DAC and used to determine the output bits in succession
from MSB to LSB. A block diagram of one SAR ADC is shown in
Figure 8-5.
Figure 8-5. SAR ADC Block Diagram
vrefp
vrefn
S/H
DAC
array
D0:D11
vin
comparator
autozero
reset
clock
clock
POWER
GROUND
power
filtering
vrefp
vrefn
SAR
digital
D0:D11
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
The input is connected to the analog globals and muxes. The
frequency of the clock is 18 times the sample rate; the clock rate
ranges from 1 to 18 MHz.
8.3.2 Conversion Signals
Writing a start bit or assertion of a start of frame (SOF) signal is
used to start a conversion. SOF can be used in applications
where the sampling period is longer than the conversion time, or
when the ADC needs to be synchronized to other hardware. This
signal is optional and does not need to be connected if the SAR
ADC is running in a continuous mode. A digital clock or UDB
output can be used to drive this input. When the SAR is first
powered up or awakened from any of the sleeping modes, there
is a power up wait time of 10 µs before it is ready to start the first
conversion.
When the conversion is complete, a status bit is set and the
output signal end of frame (EOF) asserts and remains asserted
until the value is read by either the DMA controller or the CPU.
The EOF signal may be used to trigger an interrupt or a DMA
request.
8.3.3 Operational Modes
A ONE_SHOT control bit is used to set the SAR ADC conversion
mode to either continuous or one conversion per SOF signal.
DMA transfer of continuous samples, without CPU intervention,
is supported.
8.4 Comparators
The CY8C58LP family of devices contains four comparators.
Comparators have these features:
■
Input offset factory trimmed to less than 5 mV
■
Rail-to-rail common mode input range (VSSA to VDDA)
■
Speed and power can be traded off by using one of three
modes: fast, slow, or ultra low power
■
Comparator outputs can be routed to look up tables to perform
simple logic functions and then can also be routed to digital
blocks
■
The positive input of the comparators may be optionally passed
through a low pass filter. Two filters are provided
■
Comparator inputs can be connections to GPIO, DAC outputs
and SC block outputs
8.4.1 Input and Output Interface
The positive and negative inputs to the comparators come from the analog global buses, the analog mux line, the analog local bus
and precision reference through multiplexers. The output from each comparator could be routed to any of the two input LUTs. The
output of that LUT is routed to the UDB DSI.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 51 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
Figure 8-6. Analog Comparator
From
Analog
Routing
From
Analog
Routing
ANAIF
+
comp0
_
+
comp1
_
+
_
comp3
+
_
From
Analog
Routing
From
Analog
Routing
comp2
4
4
LUT0
4
4
4
LUT1
4
LUT2
4
4
LUT3
UDBs
8.4.2 LUT
The CY8C58LP family of devices contains four LUTs. The LUT
is a two input, one output lookup table that is driven by any one
or two of the comparators in the chip. The output of any LUT is
routed to the digital system interface of the UDB array. From the
digital system interface of the UDB array, these signals can be
connected to UDBs, DMA controller, I/O, or the interrupt
controller.
The LUT control word written to a register sets the logic function
on the output. The available LUT functions and the associated
control word is shown in Table 8-2.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Table 8-2. LUT Function vs. Program Word and Inputs
Control Word
0000b
0001b
0010b
0011b
0100b
0101b
0110b
0111b
1000b
1001b
1010b
1011b
1100b
1101b
1110b
1111b
Output (A and B are LUT inputs)
FALSE (‘0’)
A AND B
A AND (NOT B)
A
(NOT A) AND B
B
A XOR B
A OR B
A NOR B
A XNOR B
NOT B
A OR (NOT B)
NOT A
(NOT A) OR B
A NAND B
TRUE (‘1’)
Page 52 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
8.5 Opamps
8.6 Programmable SC/CT Blocks
The CY8C58LP family of devices contain four general purpose
opamps.
The CY8C58LP family of devices contains four switched
capacitor/continuous time (SC/CT) blocks. Each switched
capacitor/continuous time block is built around a single rail-to-rail
high bandwidth opamp.
Figure 8-7. Opamp
GPIO
Analog
Global Bus
Opamp
Analog
Global Bus
VREF
Analog
Internal Bus
GPIO
=
GPIO
Analog Switch
The opamp is uncommitted and can be configured as a gain
stage or voltage follower on external or internal signals.
See Figure 8-8. In any configuration, the input and output signals
can all be connected to the internal global signals and monitored
with an ADC, or comparator. The configurations are
implemented with switches between the signals and GPIO pins.
Figure 8-8. Opamp Configurations
a) Voltage Follower
Opamp
Vout to Pin
Vin
b) External Uncommitted
Opamp
Opamp
Vout to GPIO
c) Internal Uncommitted
Opamp
Vout to Pin
Vp
GPIO Pin
The opamp has three speed modes, slow, medium, and fast. The
slow mode consumes the least amount of quiescent power and
the fast mode consumes the most power. The inputs are able to
swing rail-to-rail. The output swing is capable of rail-to-rail
operation at low current output, within 50 mV of the rails. When
driving high current loads (about 25 mA) the output voltage may
only get within 500 mV of the rails.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
The same opamps and block interfaces are also connectable to
an array of resistors which allows the construction of a variety of
continuous time functions.
The opamp and resistor array is programmable to perform
various analog functions including
■
Naked Operational Amplifier - Continuous Mode
■
Unity-Gain Buffer - Continuous Mode
■
Programmable Gain Amplifier (PGA) - Continuous Mode
■
Transimpedance Amplifier (TIA) - Continuous Mode
■
Up/Down Mixer - Continuous Mode
■
Sample and Hold Mixer (NRZ S/H) - Switched Cap Mode
■
First Order Analog to Digital Modulator - Switched Cap Mode
The Naked Opamp presents both inputs and the output for
connection to internal or external signals. The opamp has a unity
gain bandwidth greater than 6.0 MHz and output drive current up
to 650 µA. This is sufficient for buffering internal signals (such as
DAC outputs) and driving external loads greater than 7.5 kohms.
8.6.2 Unity Gain
The Unity Gain buffer is a Naked Opamp with the output directly
connected to the inverting input for a gain of 1.00. It has a -3 dB
bandwidth greater than 6.0 MHz.
8.6.3 PGA
Vn
Opamp
The PSoC Creator tool offers a user friendly interface, which
allows you to easily program the SC/CT blocks. Switch control
and clock phase control configuration is done by PSoC Creator
so users only need to determine the application use parameters
such as gain, amplifier polarity, VREF connection, and so on.
8.6.1 Naked Opamp
Vp to GPIO
Vn to GPIO
To Internal Signals
Switched capacitor is a circuit design technique that uses
capacitors plus switches instead of resistors to create analog
functions. These circuits work by moving charge between
capacitors by opening and closing different switches.
Nonoverlapping in phase clock signals control the switches, so
that not all switches are ON simultaneously.
The PGA amplifies an external or internal signal. The PGA can
be configured to operate in inverting mode or noninverting mode.
The PGA function may be configured for both positive and
negative gains as high as 50 and 49 respectively. The gain is
adjusted by changing the values of R1 and R2 as illustrated in
Figure 8-9. The schematic in Figure 8-9 shows the configuration
and possible resistor settings for the PGA. The gain is switched
from inverting and non inverting by changing the shared select
value of the both the input muxes. The bandwidth for each gain
case is listed in Table 8-3.
Page 53 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
The TIA configuration is used for applications where an external
sensor's output is current as a function of some type of stimulus
such as temperature, light, magnetic flux etc. In a common
application, the voltage DAC output can be connected to the
VREF TIA input to allow calibration of the external sensor bias
current by adjusting the voltage DAC output voltage.
Table 8-3. Bandwidth
Gain
1
24
48
50
Bandwidth
6.0 MHz
340 kHz
220 kHz
215 kHz
8.7 LCD Direct Drive
Figure 8-9. PGA Resistor Settings
Vin
0
Vref
1
R1
R2
20 k to 980 k
20 k or 40 k
S
Vref
0
Vin
1
The PGA is used in applications where the input signal may not
be large enough to achieve the desired resolution in the ADC, or
dynamic range of another SC/CT block such as a mixer. The gain
is adjustable at runtime, including changing the gain of the PGA
prior to each ADC sample.
8.6.4 TIA
The Transimpedance Amplifier (TIA) converts an internal or
external current to an output voltage. The TIA uses an internal
feedback resistor in a continuous time configuration to convert
input current to output voltage.For an input current Iin, the output
voltage is VREF - Iin x Rfb, where VREF is the value placed on the
non inverting input. The feedback resistor Rfb is programmable
between 20 KΩ and 1 MΩ through a configuration register.
Table 8-4 shows the possible values of Rfb and associated
configuration settings.
Table 8-4. Feedback Resistor Settings
Configuration Word
000b
001b
010b
011b
100b
101b
110b
111b
Nominal Rfb (KΩ)
20
30
40
60
120
250
500
1000
Figure 8-10. Continuous Time TIA Schematic
The PSoC Liquid Crystal Display (LCD) driver system is a highly
configurable peripheral designed to allow PSoC to directly drive
a broad range of LCD glass. All voltages are generated on chip,
eliminating the need for external components. With a high
multiplex ratio of up to 1/16, the CY8C58LP family LCD driver
system can drive a maximum of 736 segments. The PSoC LCD
driver module was also designed with the conservative power
budget of portable devices in mind, enabling different LCD drive
modes and power down modes to conserve power.
PSoC Creator provides an LCD segment drive component. The
component wizard provides easy and flexible configuration of
LCD resources. You can specify pins for segments and
commons along with other options. The software configures the
device to meet the required specifications. This is possible
because of the programmability inherent to PSoC devices.
Key features of the PSoC LCD segment system are:
■ LCD panel direct driving
■ Type A (standard) and Type B (low power) waveform support
■ Wide operating voltage range support (2 V to 5 V) for LCD
panels
■ Static, 1/2, 1/3, 1/4, 1/5 bias voltage levels
■ Internal bias voltage generation through internal resistor ladder
■ Up to 62 total common and segment outputs
■ Up to 1/16 multiplex for a maximum of 16 backplane/common
outputs
■ Up to 62 front plane/segment outputs for direct drive
■ Drives up to 736 total segments (16 backplane x 46 front plane)
■ Up to 64 levels of software controlled contrast
■ Ability to move display data from memory buffer to LCD driver
through DMA (without CPU intervention)
■ Adjustable LCD refresh rate from 10 Hz to 150 Hz
■ Ability to invert LCD display for negative image
■ Three LCD driver drive modes, allowing power optimization
Figure 8-11. LCD System
LCD
DAC
Global
Clock
UDB
LCD Driver
Block
R fb
DMA
PIN
Display
RAM
I in
V ref
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
V out
PHUB
Page 54 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
8.7.1 LCD Segment Pin Driver
Each GPIO pin contains an LCD driver circuit. The LCD driver
buffers the appropriate output of the LCD DAC to directly drive
the glass of the LCD. A register setting determines whether the
pin is a common or segment. The pin’s LCD driver then selects
one of the six bias voltages to drive the I/O pin, as appropriate
for the display data.
8.7.2 Display Data Flow
The LCD segment driver system reads display data and
generates the proper output voltages to the LCD glass to
produce the desired image. Display data resides in a memory
buffer in the system SRAM. Each time you need to change the
common and segment driver voltages, the next set of pixel data
moves from the memory buffer into the Port Data Registers via
DMA.
8.7.3 UDB and LCD Segment Control
A UDB is configured to generate the global LCD control signals
and clocking. This set of signals is routed to each LCD pin driver
through a set of dedicated LCD global routing channels. In
addition to generating the global LCD control signals, the UDB
also produces a DMA request to initiate the transfer of the next
frame of LCD data.
8.7.4 LCD DAC
The LCD DAC generates the contrast control and bias voltage
for the LCD system. The LCD DAC produces up to five LCD drive
voltages plus ground, based on the selected bias ratio. The bias
voltages are driven out to GPIO pins on a dedicated LCD bias
bus, as required.
8.8 CapSense
The CapSense system provides a versatile and efficient means
for measuring capacitance in applications such as touch sense
buttons, sliders, proximity detection, etc. The CapSense system
uses a configuration of system resources, including a few
hardware functions primarily targeted for CapSense. Specific
resource usage is detailed in the CapSense component in PSoC
Creator.
A capacitive sensing method using a Delta-Sigma Modulator
(CSD) is used. It provides capacitance sensing using a switched
capacitor technique with a delta-sigma modulator to convert the
sensing current to a digital code.
8.9 Temp Sensor
Die temperature is used to establish programming parameters
for writing flash. Die temperature is measured using a dedicated
sensor based on a forward biased transistor. The temperature
sensor has its own auxiliary ADC.
8.10 DAC
The CY8C58LP parts contain four Digital to Analog Convertors
(DACs). Each DAC is 8-bit and can be configured for either
voltage or current output. The DACs support CapSense, power
supply regulation, and waveform generation. Each DAC has the
following features.
■
Adjustable voltage or current output in 255 steps
■
Programmable step size (range selection)
■
Eight bits of calibration to correct ± 25% of gain error
■
Source and sink option for current output
■
8 Msps conversion rate for current output
■
1 Msps conversion rate for voltage output
■
Monotonic in nature
■
Data and strobe inputs can be provided by the CPU or DMA,
or routed directly from the DSI
■
Dedicated low-resistance output pin for high-current mode
Figure 8-12. DAC Block Diagram
I source Range 1x , 8x , 64x
Reference Source Scaler Vout R 3R Iout I sink Range 1x , 8x , 64x 8.10.1 Current DAC
8.10.2 Voltage DAC
The current DAC (IDAC) can be configured for the ranges 0 to
31.875 µA, 0 to 255 µA, and 0 to 2.04 mA. The IDAC can be
configured to source or sink current.
For the voltage DAC (VDAC), the current DAC output is routed
through resistors. The two ranges available for the VDAC are 0
to 1.02 V and 0 to 4.08 V. In voltage mode any load connected
to the output of a DAC should be purely capacitive (the output of
the VDAC is not buffered).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 55 of 122
PRELIMINARY
8.11 Up/Down Mixer
In continuous time mode, the SC/CT block components are used
to build an up or down mixer. Any mixing application contains an
input signal frequency and a local oscillator frequency. The
polarity of the clock, Fclk, switches the amplifier between
inverting or noninverting gain. The output is the product of the
input and the switching function from the local oscillator, with
frequency components at the local oscillator plus and minus the
signal frequency (Fclk + Fin and Fclk - Fin) and reduced-level
frequency components at odd integer multiples of the local
oscillator frequency. The local oscillator frequency is provided by
the selected clock source for the mixer.
Continuous time up and down mixing works for applications with
input signals and local oscillator frequencies up to 1 MHz.
Figure 8-13. Mixer Configuration
C1 = 850 fF
Rmix 0 20 k or 40 k
Vin
Vref
Vout
1
sc_clk
8.12 Sample and Hold
The main application for a sample and hold, is to hold a value
stable while an ADC is performing a conversion. Some
applications require multiple signals to be sampled
simultaneously, such as for power calculations (V and I). PSoC
Creator offers a sample and hold component to support this
function.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Φ1
Vi
C1
C2
Φ1
n
Φ1
Φ2
V ref
V out
Φ2
Φ2
Φ1
Φ2
Φ1
Φ1
V ref
Φ2
C3
C4
Φ2
Vref
8.12.1 Down Mixer
8.12.2 First Order Modulator - SC Mode
sc_clk
0
Figure 8-14. Sample and Hold Topology
(Φ1 and Φ2 are opposite phases of a clock)
The S+H can be used as a mixer to down convert an input signal.
This circuit is a high bandwidth passive sample network that can
sample input signals up to 14 MHz. This sampled value is then
held using the opamp with a maximum clock rate of 4 MHz. The
output frequency is at the difference between the input frequency
and the highest integer multiple of the Local Oscillator that is less
than the input.
C2 = 1.7 pF
Rmix 0 20 k or 40 k
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
A first order modulator is constructed by placing the switched
capacitor block in an integrator mode and using a comparator to
provide a 1-bit feedback to the input. Depending on this bit, a
reference voltage is either subtracted or added to the input
signal. The block output is the output of the comparator and not
the integrator in the modulator case. The signal is downshifted
and buffered and then processed by a decimator to make a
delta-sigma converter or a counter to make an incremental
converter. The accuracy of the sampled data from the first-order
modulator is determined from several factors. The main
application for this modulator is for a low frequency ADC with
high accuracy. Applications include strain gauges,
thermocouples, precision voltage, and current measurement.
Page 56 of 122
PRELIMINARY
9. Programming, Debug Interfaces,
Resources
The Cortex-M3 has internal debugging components, tightly
integrated with the CPU, providing the following features:
■ JTAG or SWD access
■ Flash Patch and Breakpoint (FPB) block for implementing
breakpoints and code patches
■ Data Watchpoint and Trigger (DWT) block for implementing
watchpoints, trigger resources, and system profiling
■ Embedded Trace Macrocell (ETM) for instruction trace
■ Instrumentation Trace Macrocell (ITM) for support of printf-style
debugging
PSoC devices include extensive support for programming,
testing, debugging, and tracing both hardware and firmware.
Four interfaces are available: JTAG, SWD, SWV, and
TRACEPORT. JTAG and SWD support all programming and
debug features of the device. JTAG also supports standard JTAG
scan chains for board level test and chaining multiple JTAG
devices to a single JTAG connection. The SWV and
TRACEPORT provide trace output from the DWT, ETM, and
ITM. TRACEPORT is faster but uses more pins. SWV is slower
but uses only one pin.
For more information on PSoC 5 programming, refer to the
application note PSoC 5 Device Programming Specifications.
Cortex-M3 debug and trace functionality enables full device
debugging in the final system using the standard production
device. It does not require special interfaces, debugging pods,
simulators, or emulators. Only the standard programming
connections are required to fully support debug.
The PSoC Creator IDE software provides fully integrated
programming and debug support for PSoC devices. The low cost
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
MiniProg3 programmer and debugger is designed to provide full
programming and debug support of PSoC devices in conjunction
with the PSoC Creator IDE. PSoC JTAG, SWD, and SWV
interfaces are fully compatible with industry standard third party
tools.
All Cortex-M3 debug and trace modules are disabled by default
and can only be enabled in firmware. If not enabled, the only way
to reenable them is to erase the entire device, clear flash
protection, and reprogram the device with new firmware that
enables them. Disabling debug and trace features, robust flash
protection, and hiding custom analog and digital functionality
inside the PSoC device provide a level of security not possible
with multichip application solutions. Additionally, all device
interfaces can be permanently disabled (Device Security) for
applications concerned about phishing attacks due to a
maliciously reprogrammed device. Permanently disabling
interfaces is not recommended in most applications because the
designer then cannot access the device later. Because all
programming, debug, and test interfaces are disabled when
Device Security is enabled, PSoCs with Device Security enabled
may not be returned for failure analysis.
9.1 JTAG Interface
The IEEE 1149.1 compliant JTAG interface exists on four or five
pins (the nTRST pin is optional). The JTAG clock frequency can
be up to 12 MHz, or 1/3 of the CPU clock frequency for 8 and
16-bit transfers, or 1/5 of the CPU clock frequency for 32-bit
transfers, whichever is least. By default, the JTAG pins are
enabled on new devices but the JTAG interface can be disabled,
allowing these pins to be used as General Purpose I/O (GPIO)
instead. The JTAG interface is used for programming the flash
memory, debugging, I/O scan chains, and JTAG device chaining.
Page 57 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 9-1. JTAG Interface Connections between PSoC 5LP and Programmer
VDD
Host Programmer
PSoC 5
VDD
VDDD, VDDA, VDDIO0, VDDIO1, VDDIO2, VDDIO3 1, 2, 3, 4
TCK
TCK (P1[1]
TMS 5
TMS (P1[0]) 5
TDO
TDI (P1[4])
TDI
TDO (P1[3])
nTRST 6
nTRST (P1[5]) 6
XRES
XRES or P1[2] 4
GND
VSSD, VSSA
GND
1
The voltage levels of Host Programmer and the PSoC 5 voltage domains involved in Programming should be same.
The Port 1 JTAG pins, XRES pin (XRES_N or P1[2]) are powered by VDDIO1. So, VDDIO1 of PSoC 5 should be at same
voltage level as host VDD. Rest of PSoC 5 voltage domains ( VDDD, VDDA, VDDIO0, VDDIO2, VDDIO3) need not be at the same
voltage level as host Programmer.
2
Vdda must be greater than or equal to all other power supplies (Vddd, Vddio’s) in PSoC 5.
3
For Power cycle mode Programming, XRES pin is not required. But the Host programmer must have
the capability to toggle power (Vddd, Vdda, All Vddio’s) to PSoC 5. This may typically require external
interface circuitry to toggle power which will depend on the programming setup. The power supplies can
be brought up in any sequence, however, once stable, VDDA must be greater than or equal to all other
supplies.
4
For JTAG Programming, Device reset can also be done without connecting to the XRES pin or Power cycle mode by
using the TMS,TCK,TDI, TDO pins of PSoC 5, and writing to a specific register. But this requires that the DPS setting
in NVL is not equal to “Debug Ports Disabled”.
5
By default, PSoC 5 is configured for 4-wire JTAG mode unless user changes the DPS setting. So the TMS pin is
unidirectional. But if the DPS setting is changed to non-JTAG mode, the TMS pin in JTAG is bi-directional as the SWD
Protocol has to be used for acquiring the PSoC 5 device initially. After switching from SWD to JTAG mode, the TMS
pin will be uni-directional. In such a case, unidirectional buffer should not be used on TMS line.
6
nTRST JTAG pin (P1[5]) cannot be used to reset the JTAG TAP controlller during first time programming of PSoC 5
as the default setting is 4-wire JTAG (nTRST disabled). Use the TMS, TCK pins to do a reset of JTAG TAP controller.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 58 of 122
PRELIMINARY
9.2 SWD Interface
The SWD interface is the preferred alternative to the JTAG
interface. It requires only two pins instead of the four or five
needed by JTAG. SWD provides all of the programming and
debugging features of JTAG at the same speed. SWD does not
provide access to scan chains or device chaining. The SWD
clock frequency can be up to 1/3 of the CPU clock frequency.
SWD uses two pins, either two of the JTAG pins (TMS and TCK)
or the USBIO D+ and D- pins. The USBIO pins are useful for in
system programming of USB solutions that would otherwise
require a separate programming connector. One pin is used for
the data clock and the other is used for data input and output.
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
SWD can be enabled on only one of the pin pairs at a time. This
only happens if, within 8 µs (key window) after reset, that pin pair
(JTAG or USB) receives a predetermined sequence of 1s and 0s.
SWD is used for debugging or for programming the flash
memory.
The SWD interface can be enabled from the JTAG interface or
disabled, allowing its pins to be used as GPIO. Unlike JTAG, the
SWD interface can always be reacquired on any device during
the key window. It can then be used to reenable the JTAG
interface, if desired. When using SWD or JTAG pins as standard
GPIO, make sure that the GPIO functionality and PCB circuits do
not interfere with SWD or JTAG use.
Figure 9-2. SWD Interface Connections between PSoC 5LP and Programmer
VDD
Host Programmer
VDDD, VDDA, VDDIO0, VDDIO1, VDDIO2, VDDIO3 1, 2, 3
VDD
SWDCK
SWDCK (P1[1] or P15[7])
SWDIO
SWDIO (P1[0] or P15[6])
XRES or P1[2] 3
XRES
GND
PSoC 5
GND
VSSD, VSSA
1
The voltage levels of the Host Programmer and the PSoC 5 voltage domains involved in
programming should be the same. XRES pin (XRES_N or P1[2]) is powered by VDDIO1. The USB SWD
pins are powered by VDDD. So for Programming using the USB SWD pins with XRES pin, the VDDD, VDDIO1 of PSoC 5 should be at the same voltage level as Host VDD. Rest of PSoC 5 voltage domains
( VDDA, VDDIO0, VDDIO2, VDDIO3) need not be at the same voltage level as host Programmer. The Port 1 SWD
pins are powered by VDDIO1. So VDDIO1 of PSoC 5 should be at same voltage level as host VDD for
Port 1 SWD programming. Rest of PSoC 5 voltage domains ( VDDD, VDDA, VDDIO0, VDDIO2, VDDIO3) need not
be at the same voltage level as host Programmer.
2
Vdda must be greater than or equal to all other power supplies (Vddd, Vddio’s) in PSoC 5.
3
For Power cycle mode Programming, XRES pin is not required. But the Host programmer must have
the capability to toggle power (Vddd, Vdda, All Vddio’s) to PSoC 5. This may typically require
external interface circuitry to toggle power which will depend on the programming setup. The power
supplies can be brought up in any sequence, however, once stable, VDDA must be greater than or
equal to all other supplies.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 59 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
9.3 Debug Features
9.6 Programming Features
The CY8C58LP supports the following debug features:
■ Halt and single-step the CPU
■ View and change CPU and peripheral registers, and RAM
addresses
■ Six program address breakpoints and two literal access
breakpoints
■ Data watchpoint events to CPU
■ Patch and remap instruction from flash to SRAM
■ Debugging at the full speed of the CPU
■ Compatible with PSoC Creator and MiniProg3 programmer and
debugger
■ Standard JTAG programming and debugging interfaces make
CY8C58LP compatible with other popular third-party tools (for
example, ARM / Keil)
The JTAG and SWD interfaces provide full programming
support. The entire device can be erased, programmed, and
verified. Designers can increase flash protection levels to protect
firmware IP. Flash protection can only be reset after a full device
erase. Individual flash blocks can be erased, programmed, and
verified, if block security settings permit.
9.4 Trace Features
The following trace features are supported:
■ Instruction trace
■ Data watchpoint on access to data address, address range, or
data value
■ Trace trigger on data watchpoint
■ Debug exception trigger
■ Code profiling
■ Counters for measuring clock cycles, folded instructions,
load/store operations, sleep cycles, cycles per instruction,
interrupt overhead
■ Interrupt events trace
■ Software event monitoring, “printf-style” debugging
9.5 SWV and TRACEPORT Interfaces
The SWV and TRACEPORT interfaces provide trace data to a
debug host via the Cypress MiniProg3 or an external trace port
analyzer. The 5 pin TRACEPORT is used for rapid transmission
of large trace streams. The single pin SWV mode is used to
minimize the number of trace pins. SWV is shared with a JTAG
pin. If debugging and tracing are done at the same time then
SWD may be used with either SWV or TRACEPORT, or JTAG
may be used with TRACEPORT, as shown in Table 9-1.
Table 9-1. Debug Configurations
Debug and Trace Configuration
All debug and trace disabled
GPIO Pins Used
0
JTAG
4 or 5
SWD
2
SWV
1
TRACEPORT
JTAG + TRACEPORT
5
9 or 10
SWD + SWV
3
SWD + TRACEPORT
7
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
9.7 Device Security
PSoC 5LP offers an advanced security feature called device
security, which permanently disables all test, programming, and
debug ports, protecting your application from external access.
The device security is activated by programming a 32-bit key
(0x50536F43) to a Write Once Latch (WOL).
The WOL is a type of nonvolatile latch (NVL). The cell itself is an
NVL with additional logic wrapped around it. Each WOL device
contains four bytes (32 bits) of data. The wrapper outputs a ‘1’ if
a super-majority (28 of 32) of its bits match a pre-determined
pattern (0x50536F43); it outputs a ‘0’ if this majority is not
reached. When the output is 1, the Write Once NV latch locks the
part out of Debug and Test modes; it also permanently gates off
the ability to erase or alter the contents of the latch. Matching all
bits is intentionally not required, so that single (or few) bit failures
do not deassert the WOL output. The state of the NVL bits after
wafer processing is truly random with no tendency toward 1 or 0.
The WOL only locks the part after the correct 32-bit key
(0x50536F43) is loaded into the NVL's volatile memory,
programmed into the NVL's nonvolatile cells, and the part is
reset. The output of the WOL is only sampled on reset and used
to disable the access. This precaution prevents anyone from
reading, erasing, or altering the contents of the internal memory.
The user can write the key into the WOL to lock out external
access only if no flash protection is set (see “Flash Security”
section on page 17). However, after setting the values in the
WOL, a user still has access to the part until it is reset. Therefore,
a user can write the key into the WOL, program the flash
protection data, and then reset the part to lock it.
If the device is protected with a WOL setting, Cypress cannot
perform failure analysis and, therefore, cannot accept RMAs
from customers. The WOL can be read out via SWD port to
electrically identify protected parts. The user can write the key in
WOL to lock out external access only if no flash protection is set.
For more information on how to take full advantage of the
security features in PSoC see the PSoC 5 TRM.
Disclaimer
Note the following details of the flash code protection features on
Cypress devices.
Cypress products meet the specifications contained in their
particular Cypress datasheets. Cypress believes that its family of
products is one of the most secure families of its kind on the
market today, regardless of how they are used. There may be
methods, unknown to Cypress, that can breach the code
protection features. Any of these methods, to our knowledge,
would be dishonest and possibly illegal. Neither Cypress nor any
other semiconductor manufacturer can guarantee the security of
their code. Code protection does not mean that we are
guaranteeing the product as “unbreakable.”
Cypress is willing to work with the customer who is concerned
about the integrity of their code. Code protection is constantly
evolving. We at Cypress are committed to continuously
improving the code protection features of our products.
Page 60 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
10. Development Support
The CY8C58LP family has a rich set of documentation,
development tools, and online resources to assist you during
your
development
process.
Visit
psoc.cypress.com/getting-started to find out more.
10.1 Documentation
A suite of documentation, to ensure that you can find answers to
your questions quickly, supports the CY8C58LP family. This
section contains a list of some of the key documents.
Software User Guide: A step-by-step guide for using PSoC
Creator. The software user guide shows you how the PSoC
Creator build process works in detail, how to use source control
with PSoC Creator, and much more.
Component Datasheets: The flexibility of PSoC allows the
creation of new peripherals (components) long after the device
has gone into production. Component datasheets provide all of
the information needed to select and use a particular component,
including a functional description, API documentation, example
code, and AC/DC specifications.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Application Notes: PSoC application notes discuss a particular
application of PSoC in depth; examples include brushless DC
motor control and on-chip filtering. Application notes often
include example projects in addition to the application note
document.
Technical Reference Manual: PSoC Creator makes designing
with PSoC as easy as dragging a peripheral onto a schematic,
but, when low level details of the PSoC device are required, use
the technical reference manual (TRM) as your guide.
Note Visit www.arm.com for detailed documentation about the
Cortex-M3 CPU.
10.2 Online
In addition to print documentation, the Cypress PSoC forums
connect you with fellow PSoC users and experts in PSoC from
around the world, 24 hours a day, 7 days a week.
10.3 Tools
With industry standard cores, programming, and debugging
interfaces, the CY8C58LP family is part of a development tool
ecosystem. Visit us at www.cypress.com/go/psoccreator for the
latest information on the revolutionary, easy to use PSoC Creator
IDE, supported third party compilers, programmers, debuggers,
and development kits.
Page 61 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11. Electrical Specifications
Specifications are valid for –40 °C ≤ TA ≤ 85 °C and TJ ≤ 100 °C, except where noted. Specifications are valid for 1.71 V to 5.5 V,
except where noted. The unique flexibility of the PSoC UDBs and analog blocks enable many functions to be implemented in PSoC
Creator components, see the component datasheets for full AC/DC specifications of individual functions. See the “Example
Peripherals” section on page 36 for further explanation of PSoC Creator components.
11.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings
Table 11-1. Absolute Maximum Ratings DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–55
25
100
°C
Analog supply voltage relative to
VSSA
–0.5
–
6
V
VDDD
Digital supply voltage relative to
VSSD
–0.5
–
6
V
VDDIO
I/O supply voltage relative to VSSD
–0.5
–
6
V
VCCA
Direct analog core voltage input
–0.5
–
1.95
V
VCCD
Direct digital core voltage input
–0.5
–
1.95
V
VSSA
Analog ground voltage
VSSD – 0.5
–
VSSD +
0.5
V
VGPIO[13]
DC input voltage on GPIO
Includes signals sourced by VDDA
and routed internal to the pin.
VSSD – 0.5
–
VDDIO +
0.5
V
VSIO
DC input voltage on SIO
Output disabled
VSSD – 0.5
–
7
V
Output enabled
VSSD – 0.5
–
6
V
0.5
–
5.5
V
VSSD – 0.5
–
5.5
V
–
–
100
mA
TSTG
Storage temperature
VDDA
VIND
Voltage at boost converter input
Conditions
Extended duration storage
temperatures above 100 °C
degrade reliability.
VBAT
Boost converter supply
IVDDIO
Current per VDDIO supply pin
IGPIO
GPIO current
–30
–
41
mA
ISIO
SIO current
–49
–
28
mA
IUSBIO
USBIO current
–56
–
59
mA
VEXTREF
ADC external reference inputs
–
–
2
V
–140
–
140
mA
Pins P0[3], P3[2]
current[14]
LU
Latch up
ESDHBM
Electrostatic discharge voltage
Human body model
2000
–
–
V
ESDCDM
ESD voltage
Charge device model
500
–
–
V
Note Usage above the absolute maximum conditions listed in Table 11-1 may cause permanent damage to the device. Exposure to
maximum conditions for extended periods of time may affect device reliability. When used below maximum conditions but above
normal operating conditions the device may not operate to specification.
Notes
13. The VDDIO supply voltage must be greater than the maximum voltage on the associated GPIO pins. Maximum voltage on GPIO pin ≤ VDDIO ≤ VDDA.
14. Meets or exceeds JEDEC Spec EIA/JESD78 IC Latch-up Test.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 62 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.2 Device Level Specifications
Specifications are valid for –40 °C ≤ TA ≤ 85 °C and TJ ≤ 100 °C, except where noted. Specifications are valid for 1.71 V to 5.5 V,
except where noted. Unless otherwise specified, all charts and graphs show typical values.
11.2.1 Device Level Specifications
Table 11-2. DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
VDDA
Analog supply voltage and input to analog core
regulator
VDDA
Analog supply voltage, analog regulator bypassed
VDDD
Digital supply voltage relative to VSSD
Digital supply voltage, digital regulator bypassed
VDDD
[16]
VDDIO
I/O supply voltage relative to VSSIO
Direct analog core voltage input (Analog regulator
VCCA
bypass)
VCCD
Direct digital core voltage input (Digital regulator
bypass)
Active Mode
Sum of digital and analog IDDD + IDDA. IDDIOX for
IDD[17]
I/Os not included. IMO enabled, bus clock and CPU
clock enabled. CPU executing complex program
from flash.[18]
Conditions
Analog core regulator enabled
Min
1.8
Typ
–
Max
5.5
Units
V
Analog core regulator disabled
Digital core regulator enabled
Digital core regulator disabled
Analog core regulator disabled
1.71
1.8
1.71
1.71
1.71
1.8
–
1.8
–
1.8
1.89
VDDA[15]
1.89
VDDA[15]
1.89
V
V
V
V
V
Digital core regulator disabled
1.71
1.8
1.89
V
1.9
1.9
2
3.1
3.1
3.2
5.4
5.4
5.6
8.9
8.9
9.1
15.5
15.4
15.7
18
18
18.5
3.8
3.8
3.8
5
5
5
7
7
7
10.5
10.5
10.5
17
17
17
19.5
19.5
19.5
mA
VDDX = 2.7 V to 5.5 V;
FCPU = 3 MHz
T = –40 °C
–
T = 25 °C
–
T = 85 °C
–
VDDX = 2.7 V to 5.5 V;
FCPU = 6 MHz
T = –40 °C
–
T = 25 °C
–
T = 85 °C
–
VDDX = 2.7 V to 5.5 V;
FCPU = 12 MHz
T = –40 °C
–
T = 25 °C
–
T = 85 °C
–
VDDX = 2.7 V to 5.5 V;
FCPU = 24 MHz
T = –40 °C
–
T = 25 °C
–
T = 85 °C
–
VDDX = 2.7 V to 5.5 V;
FCPU = 48 MHz
T = –40 °C
–
T = 25 °C
–
T = 85 °C
–
VDDX = 2.7 V to 5.5 V;
FCPU = 62 MHz
T = –40 °C
–
T = 25 °C
–
T = 85 °C
–
Notes
15. The power supplies can be brought up in any sequence however once stable Vdda must be greater than or equal to all other supplies.
16. The VDDIO supply voltage must be greater than the maximum voltage on the associated GPIO pins. Maximum voltage on GPIO pin ≤ VDDIO ≤ VDDA.
17. The current consumption of additional peripherals that are implemented only in programmed logic blocks can be found in their respective datasheets, available in
PSoC Creator, the integrated design environment. To estimate total current, find CPU current at frequency of interest and add peripheral currents for your particular
system from the device datasheet and component datasheets.
18. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 63 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 11-2. DC Specifications (continued)
Parameter
IDD[17]
Sleep Mode[21]
Description
Conditions
VDD = VDDIO = 4.5–5.5 V
CPU = OFF
RTC = ON (= ECO32K ON, in low-power mode)
Sleep timer = ON (= ILO ON at 1 kHz)[21]
VDD = VDDIO = 2.7–3.6 V
WDT = OFF
I2C Wake = OFF
Comparator = OFF
POR = ON
Boost = OFF
SIO pins in single ended input, unregulated output VDD = VDDIO = 1.71–1.95 V
mode
Min
Typ
Max
Units
T = –40 °C
–
–
–
1.9
2.4
5
1.7
2
4.2
1.6
1.9
4.2
3
3.1
3.6
16
3.1
3.6
16
3.1
3.6
16
4.2
µA
T = 25 °C
–
1.7
3.6
µA
–
0.2
0.24
2.6
0.11
0.3
2
0.9
0.11
1.8
0.3
1.4
1.1
0.7
15
2
2
15
2
2
15
2
2
15
0.6
3.3
3.1
3.1
21
µA
T = 85 °C
–
T = –40 °C
–
T = 25 °C
–
T = 85 °C
–
T = –40 °C
–
T = 25 °C
–
T = 85 °C
–
Comparator = ON
VDD = VDDIO = 2.7–3.6 V[20] T = 25 °C
CPU = OFF
RTC = OFF
Sleep timer = OFF
WDT = OFF
I2C Wake = OFF
POR = ON
Boost = OFF
SIO pins in single ended input, unregulated output
mode
I2C Wake = ON
VDD = VDDIO = 2.7–3.6 V[20] T = 25 °C
CPU = OFF
RTC = OFF
Sleep timer = OFF
WDT = OFF
Comparator = OFF
POR = ON
Boost = OFF
SIO pins in single ended input, unregulated output
mode
Hibernate Mode[19]
T = –40 °C
VDD = VDDIO = 4.5–5.5 V
T = 25 °C
Hibernate mode current
All regulators and oscillators off.
VDD = VDDIO = 2.7–3.6 V
SRAM retention
GPIO interrupts are active
Boost = OFF
SIO pins in single ended input, unregulated output
mode
VDD = VDDIO = 1.71–1.95 V
IDDAR
[20]
IDDDR[20]
–
T = 85 °C
–
T = –40 °C
–
T = 25 °C
–
T = 85 °C
–
T = –40 °C
–
T = 25 °C
–
T = 85 °C
–
VDDA ≤ 3.6 V
VDDA > 3.6 V
Digital current consumption while device is reset[20] VDDD ≤ 3.6 V
VDDD > 3.6 V
Analog current consumption while device is
reset[20]
IDD_PROG[20] Current consumption while device programming.
Sum of digital, analog, and I/Os: IDDD + IDDA +
IDDIOX.
–
–
–
–
–
µA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
Notes
19. If VCCD and VCCA are externally regulated, the voltage difference between VCCD and VCCA must be less than 50 mV.
20. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
21. Sleep timer generates periodic interrupts to wake up the CPU. This specification applies only to those times that the CPU is off.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 64 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-1. IDD vs Frequency at 25 °C
Table 11-3. AC Specifications[23]
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
FCPU
CPU frequency
1.71 V ≤ VDDD ≤ 5.5 V
DC
–
67.01
MHz
FBUSCLK
Bus frequency
1.71 V ≤ VDDD ≤ 5.5 V
DC
–
67.01
MHz
Svdd
VDD ramp rate
–
–
0.066
V/µs
TIO_INIT
Time from VDDD/VDDA/VCCD/VCCA ≥ IPOR to
I/O ports set to their reset states
–
–
10
µs
TSTARTUP
Time from VDDD/VDDA/VCCD/VCCA ≥ PRES VCCA/VDDA = regulated from
to CPU executing code at reset vector
VDDA/VDDD, no PLL used, fast IMO
boot mode (48 MHz typ.)
–
–
33
µs
–
–
66
µs
Wakeup from sleep mode –
Application of non-LVD interrupt to beginning
of execution of next CPU instruction
–
–
25
µs
THIBERNATE Wakeup from hibernate mode – Application
of external interrupt to beginning of
execution of next CPU instruction
–
–
125
µs
VCCA/VCCD = regulated from
VDDA/VDDD, no PLL used, slow IMO
boot mode (12 MHz typ.)
TSLEEP
11.3 Power Regulators
Specifications are valid for –40 °C ≤ TA ≤ 85 °C and TJ ≤ 100 °C, except where noted. Specifications are valid for 1.71 V to 5.5 V,
except where noted.
11.3.1 Digital Core Regulator
Table 11-4. Digital Core Regulator DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
VDDD
Input voltage
Output voltage
VCCD
Regulator output capacitor
Conditions
±10%, X5R ceramic or better. The two VCCD
pins must be shorted together, with as short
a trace as possible, see “Power System”
section on page 24
Min
1.8
–
–
Typ
–
1.80
1
Max
5.5
–
–
Units
V
V
µF
Notes
22. Based on device characterization (not production tested). USBIO pins tied to ground (VSSD).
23. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 65 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
Figure 11-2. Analog and Digital Regulators, VCC vs VDD,
10 mA Load
Figure 11-3. Digital Regulator PSRR vs Frequency and VDD
90
80
PSRR, dB
P
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0.1
1
10
Frequency, kHz
4.5
3.6
100
1000
2.7
11.3.2 Analog Core Regulator
Table 11-5. Analog Core Regulator DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Input voltage
VDDA
Output voltage
VCCA
Regulator output capacitor
Conditions
±10%, X5R ceramic or better
Min
1.8
–
–
Typ
–
1.80
1
Max
5.5
–
–
Units
V
V
µF
Figure 11-4. Analog Regulator PSRR vs Frequency and VDD
70
60
PSRR, dB
P
50
40
30
20
10
0
0.1
1
10
Frequency, kHz
4.5
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
3.6
100
1000
2.7
Page 66 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.3.3 Inductive Boost Regulator
Table 11-6. Inductive Boost Regulator DC Specifications[26]
Unless otherwise specified, operating conditions are: LBOOST = 10 μH, CBOOST = 22 μF || 0.1 μF, 2 < VBAT:VOUT ≤ 4.
Parameter
VBAT
Description
Input voltage, includes
IOUT
startup voltage[24]
Load current, steady
state[24, 25]
Conditions
IOUT < 7.5 mA, VOUT = 1.8 V nominal
External diode required if VBAT < 0.9 V
Min
0.5
0.6
Typ
–
–
Max
0.6
3.6
Units
V
V
VBAT = 1.6 – 3.6 V, VOUT = 1.6 – 3.6 V
–
–
75
mA
VBAT = 1.6 – 3.6 V, VOUT = 3.6 – 5.0 V, external
–
–
50
mA
diode
VBAT = 0.5 – 1.6 V, VOUT = 1.6 – 3.6 V
–
–
15
mA
VBAT = 0.5 – 1.6 V, VOUT = 3.6 – 5.0 V, external
–
–
15
mA
–
–
700
mA
–
–
250
25
–
–
µA
µA
1.71
1.81
1.90
2.28
2.57
2.85
3.14
3.42
4.75
–
1.8
1.90
2.00
2.40
2.70
3.00
3.30
3.60
5.00
–
1.89
2.00
2.10
2.52
2.84
3.15
3.47
3.78
5.25
4
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
ratio
diode
ILPK
Inductor peak current
IQ
Quiescent current
Boost active mode
Boost sleep mode, IOUT < 1 µA
VOUT
Boost output voltage
1.8 V nominal
1.9 V nominal
2.0 V nominal
2.4 V nominal
2.7 V nominal
3.0 V nominal
3.3 V nominal
3.6 V nominal, External diode required
5.0 V nominal, External diode required
VOUT : VBAT
Ratio of VOUT to VBAT
RegLOAD
Load regulation
–
–
5
%
RegLINE
Line regulation
–
–
5
%
Notes
24. For Vbat ≤ 0.9 V or Vout ≥ 3.6 V, an external diode is required.
25. If powering the PSoC from boost with Vbat = 0.5 V, the IMO must be 3 MHz at startup.
26. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 67 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 11-7. Inductive Boost Regulator AC Specifications
Parameter
VRIPPLE
Description
Ripple voltage,
peak-to-peak[27]
Conditions
LBOOST = 10 μH, CBOOST = 22 μF || 0.1 μF, 2 <
VBAT:VOUT ≤ 4, Iout = 10 mA
Min
–
Typ
–
Max
100
Units
mV
Table 11-8. Recommended External Components for Boost Circuit
Parameter
Description
LBOOST
Boost inductor
CBOOST
Filter capacitor[27]
IF
Conditions
LBOOST = 4.7 µH
Min
Typ
Max
Units
4.7
10
22
µH
–
10
–
µF
LBOOST = 10 µH
–
22
–
µF
LBOOST = 22 µH
–
22
–
µF
1
–
–
A
20
–
–
V
External Schottky diode
average forward current
VR
Figure 11-5. Efficiency vs IOUT VBOOST = 3.3 V,
LBOOST = 10 µH[28]
Figure 11-6. Efficiency vs IOUT VBOOST = 3.3 V,
LBOOST = 22 µH[28]
Notes
27. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
28. Typical example. Actual efficiency may vary depending on external component selection, PCB layout, and other design parameters.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 68 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.4 Inputs and Outputs
Specifications are valid for –40 °C ≤ TA ≤ 85 °C and TJ ≤ 100 °C, except where noted. Specifications are valid for 1.71 V to 5.5 V,
except where noted. Unless otherwise specified, all charts and graphs show typical values.
When the power supplies ramp up, there are low-impedance connections between each GPIO pin and its VDDIO supply. This causes
the pin voltages to track VDDIO until both VDDIO and VDDA reach the IPOR voltage, which can be as high as 1.45 V. At that point, the
low-impedance connections no longer exist and the pins change to their normal NVL settings.
Also, if VDDA is less than VDDIO, a low-impedance path may exist between a GPIO and VDDA, causing the GPIO to track VDDA until
VDDA becomes greater than or equal to VDDIO.
11.4.1 GPIO
Table 11-9. GPIO DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
VIH
Input voltage high threshold
VIL
Input voltage low threshold
Conditions
CMOS Input, PRT[x]CTL = 0
CMOS Input, PRT[x]CTL = 0
VIH
Input voltage high threshold
Input voltage high threshold
Input voltage low threshold
VOH
Input voltage low threshold
Output voltage high
VOL
Output voltage low
VIH
VIL
VIL
Typ
–
–
Max
–
0.3 ×
VDDIO
Units
V
V
LVTTL Input, PRT[x]CTL = 1, VDDIO < 2.7 V 0.7 x VDDIO
LVTTL Input, PRT[x]CTL = 1, VDDIO ≥ 2.7 V
2.0
LVTTL Input, PRT[x]CTL = 1, VDDIO < 2.7 V
–
–
–
–
–
–
0.3 x
VDDIO
V
V
V
LVTTL Input, PRT[x]CTL = 1, VDDIO ≥ 2.7 V
–
IOH = 4 mA at 3.3 VDDIO
VDDIO – 0.6
IOH = 1 mA at 1.8 VDDIO
VDDIO – 0.5
IOL = 8 mA at 3.3 VDDIO
–
IOL = 3 mA at 3.3 VDDIO
–
IOL = 4 mA at 1.8 VDDIO
–
3.5
3.5
25 °C, VDDIO = 3.0 V
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
5.6
5.6
–
0.8
–
–
0.6
0.4
0.6
8.5
8.5
2
V
V
V
V
V
V
kΩ
kΩ
nA
–
5
9
pF
–
5
9
pF
–
–
10
10
20
20
pF
pF
Input voltage hysteresis
(Schmitt-Trigger)[29]
Current through protection diode
to VDDIO and VSSIO
–
40
–
mV
–
–
100
µA
Resistance pin to analog global 25 °C, VDDIO = 3.0 V
bus
Resistance pin to analog mux bus 25 °C, VDDIO = 3.0 V
–
320
–
Ω
–
220
–
Ω
Rpullup
Pull-up resistor
Rpulldown Pull-down resistor
IIL
Input leakage current (absolute
value)[29]
Input capacitance[29]
CIN
GPIOs not shared with opamp outputs,
MHzECO or kHzECO
GPIOs shared with MHzECO or
kHzECO[30]
GPIOs shared with opamp outputs
GPIOs shared with SAR inputs
VH
Idiode
Rglobal
Rmux
Min
0.7 × VDDIO
–
Notes
29. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
30. For information on designing with PSoC 3 oscillators, refer to the application note, AN54439 - PSoC® 3 and PSoC 5 External Oscillator.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 69 of 122
PRELIMINARY
Figure 11-7. GPIO Output High Voltage and Current
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-8. GPIO Output Low Voltage and Current
Table 11-10. GPIO AC Specifications[31]
Parameter
TriseF
TfallF
TriseS
TfallS
Fgpioout
Fgpioin
Description
Rise time in Fast Strong Mode
Fall time in Fast Strong Mode
Rise time in Slow Strong Mode
Fall time in Slow Strong Mode
GPIO output operating frequency
2.7 V < VDDIO < 5.5 V, fast strong drive mode
1.71 V < VDDIO < 2.7 V, fast strong drive mode
3.3 V < VDDIO < 5.5 V, slow strong drive mode
1.71 V < VDDIO < 3.3 V, slow strong drive mode
GPIO input operating frequency
Conditions
3.3 V VDDIO Cload = 25 pF
3.3 V VDDIO Cload = 25 pF
3.3 V VDDIO Cload = 25 pF
3.3 V VDDIO Cload = 25 pF
90/10% VDDIO into 25 pF
90/10% VDDIO into 25 pF
90/10% VDDIO into 25 pF
90/10% VDDIO into 25 pF
90/10% VDDIO
Figure 11-9. GPIO Output Rise and Fall Times, Fast Strong
Mode, VDDIO = 3.3 V, 25 pF Load
Min
–
–
–
–
Typ
–
–
–
–
Max
12
12
60
60
Units
ns
ns
ns
ns
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
33
20
7
3.5
66
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
Figure 11-10. GPIO Output Rise and Fall Times, Slow Strong
Mode, VDDIO = 3.3 V, 25 pF Load
Note
31. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 70 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.4.2 SIO
Table 11-11. SIO DC Specifications
Parameter
Vinmax
Description
Maximum input voltage
Vinref
Input voltage reference (differential
input mode)
Output voltage reference (regulated output mode)
VDDIO > 3.7
VDDIO < 3.7
Input voltage high threshold
GPIO mode
CMOS input
Differential input mode[32]
Hysteresis disabled
Input voltage low threshold
GPIO mode
CMOS input
[32]
Differential input mode
Hysteresis disabled
Output voltage high
Unregulated mode
IOH = 4 mA, VDDIO = 3.3 V
IOH = 1 mA
Regulated mode[32]
IOH = 0.1 mA
no load, IOH = 0
Output voltage low
VDDIO = 3.30 V, IOL = 25 mA
VDDIO = 3.30 V, IOL = 20 mA
VDDIO = 1.80 V, IOL = 4 mA
Pull-up resistor
Pull-down resistor
Input leakage current (absolute
value)[33]
VIH < Vddsio
25 °C, Vddsio = 3.0 V, VIH = 3.0 V
25 °C, Vddsio = 0 V, VIH = 3.0 V
VIH > Vddsio
Input Capacitance[33]
Input voltage hysteresis
Single ended mode (GPIO mode)
(Schmitt-Trigger)[33]
Differential mode
Current through protection diode to
VSSIO
Voutref
VIH
VIL
VOH
VOL
Rpullup
Rpulldown
IIL
CIN
VH
Idiode
Conditions
All allowed values of Vddio and
Vddd, see Section 11.2.1
Min
–
Typ
–
Max
5.5
Units
V
0.5
–
0.52 × VDDIO
V
1
1
–
–
VDDIO – 1
VDDIO – 0.5
V
V
0.7 × VDDIO
SIO_ref + 0.2
–
–
–
–
V
V
–
–
–
–
0.3 × VDDIO
SIO_ref – 0.2
V
V
VDDIO – 0.4
SIO_ref – 0.65
SIO_ref – 0.3
SIO_ref – 0.1
–
–
–
3.5
3.5
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
5.6
5.6
–
SIO_ref + 0.2
SIO_ref + 0.2
SIO_ref + 0.1
0.8
0.4
0.4
8.5
8.5
V
V
V
V
V
V
V
kΩ
kΩ
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
115
50
–
14
10
7
–
–
100
nA
µA
pF
mV
mV
µA
Notes
32. See Figure 6-9 on page 31 and Figure 6-12 on page 34 for more information on SIO reference.
33. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 71 of 122
PRELIMINARY
Figure 11-11. SIO Output HighVoltage and Current,
Unregulated Mode
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-12. SIO Output Low Voltage and Current,
Unregulated Mode
Figure 11-13. SIO Output High Voltage and Current,
Regulated Mode
SIO AC Specifications[34]
Parameter
TriseF
TfallF
TriseS
TfallS
Description
Rise time in fast strong mode
(90/10%)
Fall time in fast strong mode
(90/10%)
Conditions
Cload = 25 pF, VDDIO = 3.3 V
Min
–
Typ
–
Max
12
Units
ns
Cload = 25 pF, VDDIO = 3.3 V
–
–
12
ns
Rise time in slow strong mode
(90/10%)
Fall time in slow strong mode
(90/10%)
Cload = 25 pF, VDDIO = 3.0 V
–
–
75
ns
Cload = 25 pF, VDDIO = 3.0 V
–
–
60
ns
Note
34. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 72 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
SIO AC Specifications[34] (continued)
Parameter
Description
Min
Typ
Max
Units
90/10% VDDIO into 25 pF
–
–
33
MHz
1.71 V < VDDIO < 2.7 V, Unregulated output (GPIO) mode, fast
strong drive mode
3.3 V < VDDIO < 5.5 V, Unregulated output (GPIO) mode, slow
strong drive mode
90/10% VDDIO into 25 pF
–
–
16
MHz
90/10% VDDIO into 25 pF
–
–
5
MHz
1.71 V < VDDIO < 3.3 V, Unregulated output (GPIO) mode, slow
strong drive mode
2.7 V < VDDIO < 5.5 V, Regulated
output mode, fast strong drive
mode
1.71 V < VDDIO < 2.7 V, Regulated
output mode, fast strong drive
mode
1.71 V < VDDIO < 5.5 V, Regulated
output mode, slow strong drive
mode
SIO input operating frequency
1.71 V < VDDIO < 5.5 V
90/10% VDDIO into 25 pF
–
–
4
MHz
Output continuously switching into
25 pF
–
–
20
MHz
Output continuously switching into
25 pF
–
–
10
MHz
Output continuously switching into
25 pF
–
–
2.5
MHz
90/10% VDDIO
–
–
66
MHz
SIO output operating frequency
2.7 V < VDDIO < 5.5 V, Unregulated output (GPIO) mode, fast
strong drive mode
Fsioout
Fsioin
Conditions
Figure 11-14. SIO Output Rise and Fall Times, Fast Strong
Mode, VDDIO = 3.3 V, 25 pF Load
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Figure 11-15. SIO Output Rise and Fall Times, Slow Strong
Mode, VDDIO = 3.3 V, 25 pF Load
Page 73 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.4.3 USBIO
For operation in GPIO mode, the standard range for VDDD applies, see Device Level Specifications on page 63.
Table 11-13. USBIO DC Specifications
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Rusbi
Parameter
USB D+ pull-up resistance[35]
With idle bus
0.900
–
1.575
kΩ
Rusba
USB D+ pull-up resistance[35]
While receiving traffic
1.425
–
3.090
kΩ
Vohusb
Static output high[35]
15 kΩ ±5% to Vss, internal pull-up
enabled
2.8
–
3.6
V
Volusb
Static output low[35]
15 kΩ ±5% to Vss, internal pull-up
enabled
–
–
0.3
V
Vihgpio
Input voltage high, GPIO mode[35] VDDD = 1.8 V
Vilgpio
Description
Input voltage low, GPIO mode[35]
Conditions
1.5
–
–
V
VDDD = 3.3 V
2
–
–
V
VDDD = 5.0 V
2
–
–
V
VDDD = 1.8 V
–
–
0.8
V
VDDD = 3.3 V
–
–
0.8
V
VDDD = 5.0 V
Vohgpio
Volgpio
Output voltage high, GPIO
mode[35]
–
–
0.8
V
IOH = 4 mA, VDDD = 1.8 V
1.6
–
–
V
IOH = 4 mA, VDDD = 3.3 V
3.1
–
–
V
IOH = 4 mA, VDDD = 5.0 V
4.2
–
–
V
Output voltage low, GPIO mode[35] IOL = 4 mA, VDDD = 1.8 V
–
–
0.3
V
IOL = 4 mA, VDDD = 3.3 V
–
–
0.3
V
IOL = 4 mA, VDDD = 5.0 V
–
–
0.3
V
|(D+)–(D–)|
–
–
0.2
V
Vdi
Differential input sensitivity
Vcm
Differential input common mode
range
0.8
–
2.5
V
Vse
Single ended receiver threshold
0.8
–
2
V
Rps2
PS/2 pull-up resistance[35]
In PS/2 mode, with PS/2 pull-up
enabled
3
–
7
kΩ
Rext
External USB series resistor[35]
In series with each USB pin
21.78
(–1%)
22
22.22 (+1%)
Ω
Zo
USB driver output impedance[35]
Including Rext
CIN
USB transceiver input capacitance
IIL[35]
Input leakage current (absolute
value)[35]
25 °C, VDDD = 3.0 V
28
–
44
Ω
–
–
20
pF
–
–
2
nA
Note
35. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 74 of 122
PRELIMINARY
Figure 11-16. USBIO Output High Voltage and Current,
GPIO Mode
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-17. USBIO Output Rise and Fall Times, GPIO Mode,
VDDD = 3.3 V, 25 pF Load
Table 11-14. USBIO AC Specifications[36]
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Tdrate
Full-speed data rate average bit rate
12 – 0.25%
12
12 +
0.25%
MHz
Tjr1
Receiver data jitter tolerance to next
transition
–8
–
8
ns
Tjr2
Receiver data jitter tolerance to pair
transition
–5
–
5
ns
Tdj1
Driver differential jitter to next transition
–3.5
–
3.5
ns
Tdj2
Driver differential jitter to pair transition
–4
–
4
ns
Tfdeop
Source jitter for differential transition to
SE0 transition
–2
–
5
ns
Tfeopt
Source SE0 interval of EOP
160
–
175
ns
Tfeopr
Receiver SE0 interval of EOP
82
–
–
ns
Tfst
Width of SE0 interval during differential
transition
–
–
14
ns
Fgpio_out
GPIO mode output operating frequency 3 V ≤ VDDD ≤ 5.5 V
–
–
20
MHz
–
–
6
MHz
–
–
12
ns
–
–
40
ns
–
–
12
ns
–
–
40
ns
VDDD = 1.71 V
Tr_gpio
Rise time, GPIO mode, 10%/90% VDDD VDDD > 3 V, 25 pF load
VDDD = 1.71 V, 25 pF load
Tf_gpio
Fall time, GPIO mode, 90%/10% VDDD VDDD > 3 V, 25 pF load
VDDD = 1.71 V, 25 pF load
Note
36. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 75 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-18. USBIO Output Low Voltage and Current,
GPIO Mode
Table 11-15. USB Driver AC Specifications[37]
Parameter
Tr
Description
Conditions
Transition rise time
Tf
Transition fall time
TR
Rise/fall time matching
Vcrs
Output signal crossover voltage
VUSB_5, VUSB_3.3, see USB DC
Specifications on page 103
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
–
20
ns
ns
–
–
20
90%
–
111%
1.3
–
2
Min
0.7 × VDDIO
–
3.5
–
–
Typ
–
–
5.6
3
100
–
–
100
µA
Min
Typ
Max
Units
1
–
–
µs
V
11.4.4 XRES
Table 11-16. XRES DC Specifications
Parameter
VIH
VIL
Rpullup
CIN
VH
Idiode
Description
Input voltage high threshold
Input voltage low threshold
Pull-up resistor
Input capacitance[37]
Input voltage hysteresis
(Schmitt-Trigger)[37]
Current through protection diode to
VDDIO and VSSIO
Conditions
Max
Units
–
V
0.3 × VDDIO
V
8.5
kΩ
pF
–
mV
Table 11-17. XRES AC Specifications[37]
Parameter
TRESET
Description
Reset pulse width
Conditions
Note
37. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 76 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.5 Analog Peripherals
Specifications are valid for –40 °C ≤ TA ≤ 85 °C and TJ ≤ 100 °C, except where noted. Specifications are valid for 1.71 V to 5.5 V,
except where noted.
11.5.1 Opamp
Table 11-18. Opamp DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
VI
Input voltage range
Vos
Input offset voltage
TCVos
Ge1
Cin
Vo
Iout
Idd
CMRR
PSRR
Conditions
Min
VSSA
–
–
Operating temperature –40 °C to
70 °C
Input offset voltage drift with temperature Power mode = high
–
Gain error, unity gain buffer mode
Rload = 1 kΩ
–
Input capacitance
Routing from pin
–
Output voltage range
1 mA, source or sink, power mode VSSA + 0.05
= high
25
Output current capability, source or sink VSSA + 500 mV ≤ Vout ≤ VDDA –500
mV, VDDA > 2.7 V
16
VSSA + 500 mV ≤ Vout ≤ VDDA –500
mV, 1.7 V = VDDA ≤ 2.7 V
Quiescent current[38]
Power mode = min
–
Power mode = low
–
Power mode = med
–
Power mode = high
–
Common mode rejection ratio[38]
80
Power supply rejection ratio[38]
Vdda ≥ 2.7 V
85
Vdda < 2.7 V
70
Figure 11-19. Opamp Voffset Histogram, 3388 samples/847
parts, 25 °C, VDDA = 5 V
Typ
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
Max
VDDA
2.5
2
±30
±0.1
18
VDDA –
0.05
–
Units
V
mV
mV
µV / °C
%
pF
V
mA
–
–
mA
250
250
330
1000
–
–
–
400
400
950
2500
–
–
–
uA
uA
uA
uA
dB
dB
dB
Figure 11-20. Opamp Voffset vs Temperature, VDDA = 5 V
Note
38. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 77 of 122
PRELIMINARY
Figure 11-21. Opamp Voffset vs Vcommon and Vdda, 25 °C
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-22. Opamp Output Voltage vs Load Current and
Temperature, High Power Mode, 25 °C, Vdda = 2.7 V
Figure 11-23. Opamp Operating Current vs Vdda and Power
Mode
Table 11-19. Opamp AC Specifications[39]
Parameter
Description
GBW
Gain-bandwidth product
SR
Slew rate, 20% - 80%
en
Input noise density
Conditions
Power mode = minimum, 15 pF load
Power mode = low, 15 pF load
Power mode = medium, 200 pF load
Power mode = high, 200 pF load
Power mode = minimum, 15 pF load
Power mode = low, 15 pF load
Power mode = medium, 200 pF load
Power mode = high, 200 pF load
Power mode = high, Vdda = 5 V, at
100 kHz
Min
1
2
1
3
1.1
1.1
0.9
3
–
Typ
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
45
Max
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
Units
MHz
MHz
MHz
MHz
V/µs
V/µs
V/µs
V/µs
nV/sqrtHz
Note
39. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 78 of 122
PRELIMINARY
Figure 11-24. Opamp Noise vs Frequency, Power Mode =
High, Vdda = 5V
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-25. Opamp Step Response, Rising
nV/sqrtHz
1000
100
10
0.01
0.1
1
10
100
1000
Frequency, kHz
Figure 11-26. Opamp Step Response, Falling
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 79 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.5.2 Delta-Sigma ADC
Unless otherwise specified, operating conditions are:
■
Operation in continuous sample mode
■
fclk = 3.072 MHz for resolution = 16 to 20 bits; fclk = 6.144 MHz for resolution = 8 to 15 bits
■
Reference = 1.024 V internal reference bypassed on P3.2 or P0.3
■
Unless otherwise specified, all charts and graphs show typical values
Table 11-20. 20-bit Delta-sigma ADC DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Resolution
Number of channels, single ended
Number of channels, differential
Monotonic
Ge
Gain error
Gd
Gain drift
Vos
Input offset voltage
TCVos
Temperature coefficient, input offset
voltage
Input voltage range, single ended[40]
Input voltage range, differential unbuffered[40]
Input voltage range, differential,
buffered[40]
Differential pair is formed using a
pair of GPIOs.
Yes
Buffered, buffer gain = 1, Range =
±1.024 V, 16-bit mode, 25 °C
Buffered, buffer gain = 1, Range =
±1.024 V, 16-bit mode
Buffered, 16-bit mode, full voltage
range, 25 °C
Buffered, 16-bit mode, VDDA = 1.7 V,
25 °C
Buffer gain = 1, 16-bit,
Range = ±1.024 V
Buffer gain = 1, 16-bit,
Range = ±1.024 V
Buffer gain = 1, 16 bit,
CMRRb
Common mode rejection ratio, buffered[40]
Range = ±1.024 V
INL20
Integral non linearity[40]
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
DNL20
Differential non linearity[40]
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
INL16
Integral non linearity[40]
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
DNL16
Differential non linearity[40]
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
INL12
Integral non linearity[40]
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
DNL12
Differential non linearity[40]
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
INL8
Integral non linearity[40]
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
[40]
DNL8
Differential non linearity
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
Rin_Buff
ADC input resistance
Input buffer used
Input buffer bypassed, 16-bit,
Rin_ADC16 ADC input resistance
Range = ±1.024 V
Input buffer bypassed, 12 bit,
Rin_ADC12 ADC input resistance
Range = ±1.024 V
PSRRb
Power supply rejection ratio, buffered[40]
Min
8
Typ
–
Units
bits
–
Max
20
No. of
GPIO
No. of
GPIO/2
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
±0.4
%
–
–
50
ppm/°C
–
–
±0.2
mV
–
–
±0.1
mV
–
–
0.55
µV/°C
VSSA
–
VDDA
V
VSSA
–
VDDA
V
VSSA
–
VDDA – 1
V
90
–
–
dB
85
–
–
dB
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
10
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
±32
±1
±2
±1
±1
±1
±1
±1
–
LSB
LSB
LSB
LSB
LSB
LSB
LSB
LSB
MΩ
–
74[41]
–
kΩ
–
148[41]
–
kΩ
–
–
–
Notes
40. Based on device characterization (not production tested).
41. By using switched capacitors at the ADC input an effective input resistance is created. Holding the gain and number of bits constant, the resistance is proportional
to the inverse of the clock frequency. This value is calculated, not measured. For more information see the Technical Reference Manual.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 80 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 11-20. 20-bit Delta-sigma ADC DC Specifications (continued)
Parameter
Description
ADC external reference input voltage, see
Vextref
also internal reference in Voltage
Reference on page 84
Current Consumption
IDDA + IDDD Current consumption, 20 bit[42]
IDD_20
IDDA + IDDD Current consumption, 16 bit[42]
IDD_16
IDDA + IDDD Current consumption, 12 bit[42]
IDD_12
IDDA + IDDD Current consumption, 8 bit[42]
IDD_8
Buffer current consumption[42]
IBUFF
Conditions
Pins P0[3], P3[2]
187 sps, unbuffered
48 ksps, unbuffered
192 ksps, unbuffered
384 ksps, unbuffered
Min
Typ
Max
Units
0.9
–
1.3
V
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
1.5
1.5
1.95
1.95
2.5
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Table 11-21. Delta-sigma ADC AC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Startup time
THD
Total harmonic distortion[42]
Buffer gain = 1, 16 bit,
Range = ±1.024 V
–
–
4
Samples
–
–
0.0032
%
20-Bit Resolution Mode
SR20
Sample rate[42]
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
7.8
–
187
sps
BW20
Input bandwidth at max sample rate[42]
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
–
40
–
Hz
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
2
–
48
ksps
16-Bit Resolution Mode
SR16
BW16
Sample rate[42]
Input bandwidth at max sample
rate[42]
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
–
11
–
kHz
SINAD16int Signal to noise ratio, 16-bit, internal
reference[42]
Range = ±1.024V, unbuffered
81
–
–
dB
SINAD16ext Signal to noise ratio, 16-bit, external
reference[42]
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
84
–
–
dB
12-Bit Resolution Mode
SR12
Sample rate, continuous, high power[42]
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
4
–
192
ksps
BW12
Input bandwidth at max sample rate[42]
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
–
44
–
kHz
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
66
–
–
dB
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
8
–
384
ksps
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
–
88
–
kHz
Range = ±1.024 V, unbuffered
43
–
–
dB
SINAD12int Signal to noise ratio, 12-bit, internal
reference[42]
8-Bit Resolution Mode
SR8
Sample rate, continuous, high power[42]
rate[42]
BW8
Input bandwidth at max sample
SINAD8int
Signal to noise ratio, 8-bit, internal
reference[42]
Note
42. Based on device characterization (not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 81 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 11-22. Delta-sigma ADC Sample Rates, Range = ±1.024 V
Resolution, Bits
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
Continuous
Min
8000
6400
5566
4741
4000
3283
2783
2371
2000
500
125
16
8
Multi-Sample
Min
Max
1911
91701
1543
74024
1348
64673
1154
55351
978
46900
806
38641
685
32855
585
28054
495
11861
124
2965
31
741
4
93
2
46
Max
384000
307200
267130
227555
192000
157538
133565
113777
48000
12000
3000
375
187.5
Figure 11-27. Delta-sigma ADC IDD vs sps, Range = ±1.024 V,
Continuous Sample Mode, Input Buffer Bypassed
Multi-Sample Turbo
Min
Max
1829
87771
1489
71441
1307
62693
1123
53894
956
45850
791
37925
674
32336
577
27675
489
11725
282
6766
105
2513
15
357
8
183
Figure 11-28. Delta-sigma ADC Noise Histogram, 1000 Samples, 20-Bit, 187 sps, Ext Ref, VIN = VREF/2, Range = ±1.024 V
1.4
1.2
Current, mA
1.0
0.8
16 bit
06
0.6
12 bit
0.4
0.2
0.0
1
10
100
Sample rate, Ksps
1000
Figure 11-29. Delta-sigma ADC Noise Histogram, 1000
Samples, 16-bit, 48 ksps, Ext Ref, VIN = VREF/2, Range =
±1.024 V
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Figure 11-30. Delta-sigma ADC Noise Histogram, 1000
Samples, 16-bit, 48 ksps, Int Ref, VIN = VREF/2, Range =
±1.024 V
Page 82 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 11-23. Delta-sigma ADC RMS Noise in Counts vs. Input Range and Sample Rate, 16-bit,
Internal Reference, Single Ended[43]
Sample rate,
Input Voltage Range
sps
0 to VREF
0 to VREF x 2
VSSA to VDDA
0 to VREF x 6
2000
1.21
1.02
1.14
0.99
3000
1.28
1.15
1.25
1.22
6000
1.36
1.22
1.38
1.22
12000
1.44
1.33
1.43
1.40
24000
1.67
1.50
1.43
1.53
48000
1.91
1.60
1.85
1.67
Table 11-24. Delta-sigma ADC RMS Noise in Counts vs. Input Range and Sample Rate, 16-bit,
Internal Reference, Differential[43]
Sample rate,
Input Voltage Range
sps
±VREF
±VREF / 2
±VREF / 4
±VREF / 8
±VREF / 16
2000
0.56
0.65
0.74
1.02
1.77
4000
0.58
0.72
0.81
1.10
1.98
8000
0.53
0.72
0.82
1.12
2.18
15625
0.58
0.72
0.85
1.13
2.20
32000
0.60
0.76
43750
0.58
0.75
48000
0.59
INVALID OPERATING REGION
Table 11-25. Delta-sigma ADC RMS Noise in Counts vs. Input Range and Sample Rate, 20-bit,
External Reference, Single Ended[43]
Sample rate,
Input Voltage Range
sps
0 to VREF
0 to VREF x 2
VSSA to VDDA
0 to VREF x 6
8
1.28
1.24
6.02
0.97
23
1.33
1.28
6.09
0.98
45
1.77
1.26
6.28
0.96
90
1.65
0.91
6.84
0.95
187
1.87
1.06
7.97
1.01
Table 11-26. Delta-sigma ADC RMS Noise in Counts vs. Input Range and Sample Rate, 20-bit,
External Reference, Differential[43]
Sample rate,
Input Voltage Range
sps
±VREF
±VREF / 2
±VREF / 4
±VREF / 8
±VREF / 16
8
0.70
0.84
1.02
1.40
2.65
11.3
0.69
0.86
0.96
1.40
2.69
22.5
0.73
0.82
1.25
1.77
2.67
45
0.76
0.94
1.02
1.76
2.75
61
0.75
1.01
1.13
1.65
2.98
170
0.75
0.98
187
0.73
INVALID OPERATING REGION
Note
43. The RMS noise (in volts) is the range (in volts) times noise in counts divided by 2^number of bits. RMS Noise = (Range × Counts) / 2^bits
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 83 of 122
PRELIMINARY
Figure 11-31. Delta-sigma ADC DNL vs Output Code, 16-bit,
48 ksps, 25 °C VDDA = 3.3 V
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-32. Delta-sigma ADC INL vs Output Code, 16-bit,
48 ksps, 25 °C VDDA = 3.3 V
11.5.3 Voltage Reference
Table 11-27. Voltage Reference Specifications
See ADC external reference specifications in Section 11.5.2.
Parameter
Description
Precision reference voltage
VREF
Temperature drift[44]
Long term drift[44]
Thermal cycling drift (stability)[44]
Figure 11-33. Vref vs Temperature
Conditions
Initial trimming
Min
1.023
(–0.1%)
–
–
–
Typ
1.024
–
100
100
Max
1.025
(+0.1%)
30
–
–
Units
V
ppm/°C
ppm/Khr
ppm
Figure 11-34. Vref Long-term Drift
Note
44. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 84 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.5.4 SAR ADC
Table 11-28. SAR ADC DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Resolution
Number of channels – single-ended
Number of channels – differential
Ge
VOS
IDD
PSRR
CMRR
INL
DNL
RIN
Monotonicity[45]
Gain error[46]
Input offset voltage
Current consumption[45]
Input voltage range – single-ended[45]
Input voltage range – differential[45]
Power supply rejection ratio[45]
Common mode rejection ratio
Integral non linearity[45]
Differential non linearity[45]
Input resistance[45]
Figure 11-35. SAR ADC DNL vs Output Code,
Bypassed Internal Reference Mode
Conditions
Min
–
–
Typ
–
–
Differential pair is formed using a
pair of neighboring GPIO.
–
–
Yes
–
–
–
VSSA
VSSA
70
70
–
External reference
VDDA 1.71 to 5.5 V, 1 Msps, VREF
1 to 5.5 V
VDDA 2.0 to 3.6 V, 1 Msps, VREF
2 to VDDA
VDDA 1.71 to 5.5 V, 500 ksps,
VREF 1 to 5.5 V
VDDA 1.71 to 5.5 V, 1 Msps, VREF
1 to 5.5 V
VDDA 2.0 to 3.6 V, 1 Msps, VREF
2 to VDDA
No missing codes
VDDA 1.71 to 5.5 V, 500 ksps,
VREF 1 to 5.5 V
No missing codes
Units
bits
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
Max
12
No of
GPIO
No of
GPIO/2
–
±0.1
±2
1
VDDA
VDDA
–
–
+2/–1.5
–
–
±1.2
LSB
–
–
±1.3
LSB
–
–
+2/–1
LSB
–
–
1.7/–0.99
LSB
–
–
+2/–0.99
LSB
–
180
–
kΩ
%
mV
mA
V
V
dB
dB
LSB
Figure 11-36. SAR ADC INL vs Output Code,
Bypassed Internal Reference Mode
Notes
45. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
46. For total analog system Idd < 5 mA, depending on package used. With higher total analog system currents it is recommended that the SAR ADC be used in differential
mode.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 85 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-37. SAR ADC IDD vs sps, VDDA = 5 V, Continuous
Sample Mode, External Reference Mode
Table 11-29. SAR ADC AC Specifications[48]
Parameter
Fclk
Tc
Description
SAR clock frequency
Conversion time
SINAD
THD
Startup time
Signal-to-noise ratio
Total harmonic distortion
Conditions
One conversion requires 18 SAR
clocks. Maximum sample rate is 1
Msps
Figure 11-38. SAR ADC Noise Histogram, 1000 samples,
700 ksps, Internal Reference No Bypass, VIN = VREF/2
Min
1
1
Typ
–
–
Max
18
18
Units
MHz
µs
–
68
–
–
–
–
10
–
0.02
µs
dB
%
Figure 11-39. SAR ADC Noise Histogram, 1000
samples, 700 ksps, Internal Reference Bypassed, VIN =
VREF/2
Note
47. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 86 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-40. SAR ADC Noise Histogram, 1000 samples,
700 ksps, External Reference, VIN = VREF/2
11.5.5 Analog Globals
Table 11-30. Analog Globals DC Specifications
Parameter
Rppag
Rppmuxbus
Description
Resistance pin-to-pin through
P2[4], AGL0, DSM INP, AGL1,
P2[5][49]
Resistance pin-to-pin through
P2[3], amuxbusL, P2[4][49]
Conditions
VDDA = 3.0 V
VDDA = 1.71 V
VDDA = 3.0 V
VDDA = 1.71 V
Min
–
–
Typ
1500
1200
Max
2200
1700
Units
Ω
Ω
–
–
700
600
1100
900
Ω
Ω
Min
106
Typ
–
Max
–
Units
dB
–
26
–
MHz
Table 11-31. Analog Globals AC Specifications
Parameter
BWag
Description
Inter-pair crosstalk for analog
routes[48]
Analog globals 3 db bandwidth[49]
Conditions
VDDA = 3.0 V, 25 °C
Notes
48. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
49. The resistance of the analog global and analog mux bus is high if VDDA ≤ 2.7 V, and the chip is in either sleep or hibernate mode. Use of analog global and analog
mux bus under these conditions is not recommended.
50. This value is calculated, not measured.
51. Pin P6[4] to del-sig ADC input; calculated, not measured.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 87 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.5.6 Comparator
Table 11-32. Comparator DC Specifications[52]
Parameter
Description
Min
Input offset voltage in fast mode
Factory trim, Vdda > 2.7 V,
Vin ≥ 0.5 V
–
Input offset voltage in slow mode
Factory trim, Vin ≥ 0.5 V
–
VOS
VOS
Conditions
Input offset voltage in fast mode[53] Custom trim
Input offset voltage in slow mode[53]
–
Custom trim
Typ
Max
Units
10
mV
9
mV
4
mV
–
–
–
4
mV
VOS
Input offset voltage in ultra low
power mode
–
±12
–
mV
TCVos
Temperature coefficient, input offset VCM = VDDA / 2, fast mode
voltage
VCM = VDDA / 2, slow mode
–
63
85
µV/°C
–
15
20
VHYST
Hysteresis
Hysteresis enable mode
–
10
32
mV
VICM
Input common mode voltage
High current / fast mode
VSSA
–
VDDA
V
Low current / slow mode
VSSA
–
VDDA
V
Ultra low power mode
VSSA
–
VDDA – 1.15
V
–
50
–
dB
CMRR
Common mode rejection ratio
ICMP
High current mode/fast mode
–
–
400
µA
Low current mode/slow mode
–
–
100
µA
Ultra low power mode
–
6
–
µA
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Table 11-33. Comparator AC Specifications[52]
Parameter
TRESP
Description
Conditions
Response time, high current
mode[52]
50 mV overdrive, measured
pin-to-pin
–
75
110
ns
Response time, low current
mode[52]
50 mV overdrive, measured
pin-to-pin
–
155
200
ns
Response time, ultra low power
mode[52]
50 mV overdrive, measured
pin-to-pin
–
55
–
µs
Notes
52. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
53. The recommended procedure for using a custom trim value for the on-chip comparators can be found in the TRM.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 88 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.5.7 Current Digital-to-analog Converter (IDAC)
All specifications are based on use of the low-resistance IDAC output pins (see Pin Descriptions on page 9 for details). See the IDAC
component data sheet in PSoC Creator for full electrical specifications and APIs.
Unless otherwise specified, all charts and graphs show typical values.
Table 11-34. IDAC DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
–
8
bits
Range = 2.04 mA, code = 255,
VDDA ≥ 2.7 V, Rload = 600 Ω
–
2.04
–
mA
Range = 2.04 mA, High mode,
code = 255, VDDA ≤ 2.7 V,
Rload = 300 Ω
–
2.04
–
mA
Range = 255 µA, code = 255,
Rload = 600 Ω
–
255
–
µA
Range = 31.875 µA, code = 255,
Rload = 600 Ω
–
31.875
–
µA
–
–
Yes
Resolution
IOUT
Output current at code = 255
Monotonicity
Ezs
Zero scale error
Eg
Gain error
TC_Eg
INL
Temperature coefficient of gain
error
Integral nonlinearity
Range = 2.04 mA
–
0
±1
LSB
–
–
±2.5
%
Range = 255 µA
–
–
±2.5
%
Range = 31.875 µA
–
–
±3.5
%
Range = 2.04 mA
–
–
0.045
% / °C
Range = 255 µA
–
–
0.045
% / °C
Range = 31.875 µA
–
–
0.05
% / °C
Sink mode, range = 255 µA, Codes
8 – 255, Rload = 2.4 kΩ,
Cload = 15 pF
–
±0.9
±1
LSB
Source mode, range = 255 µA,
Codes 8 – 255, Rload = 2.4 kΩ,
Cload = 15 pF
–
±1.2
±1.5
LSB
Source mode, range = 31.875 µA,
Codes 8 - 255, Rload = 20 kΩ,
Cload = 15 pF[55]
–
±0.9
±2
LSB
Sink mode, range = 31.875 µA,
Codes 8 - 255, Rload = 20 kΩ,
Cload = 15 pF[55]
–
±0.9
±2
LSB
Souce mode, range = 2.04 mA,
Codes 8 - 255, Rload = 600 Ω,
Cload = 15 pF[55]
–
±0.9
±2
LSB
Sink mode, range = 2.04 mA,
Codes 8 - 255, Rload = 600 Ω,
Cload = 15 pF[55]
–
±0.6
±1
LSB
Notes
54. The recommended procedure for using a custom trim value for the on-chip comparators can be found in the TRM.
55. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 89 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 11-34. IDAC DC Specifications (continued)
Parameter
DNL
Description
Differential nonlinearity
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Sink mode, range = 255 µA,
Rload = 2.4 kΩ, Cload = 15 pF
–
±0.3
±1
LSB
Source mode, range = 255 µA,
Rload = 2.4 kΩ, Cload = 15 pF
–
±0.3
±1
LSB
Source mode, range = 31.875 µA,
Rload = 20 kΩ, Cload = 15 pF[56]
–
±0.2
±1
LSB
Sink mode, range = 31.875 µA,
Rload = 20 kΩ, Cload = 15 pF[56]
–
±0.2
±1
LSB
Source mode, range = 2.0 4 mA,
Rload = 600 Ω, Cload = 15 pF[56]
–
±0.2
±1
LSB
Sink mode, range = 2.0 4 mA,
Rload = 600 Ω, Cload = 15 pF[56]
–
±0.2
±1
LSB
Vcompliance
Dropout voltage, source or sink
mode
Voltage headroom at max current,
Rload to VDDA or Rload to VSSA,
VDIFF from VDDA
1
–
–
V
IDD
Operating current, code = 0
Slow mode, source mode, range =
31.875 µA
–
44
100
µA
Slow mode, source mode, range =
255 µA,
–
33
100
µA
Slow mode, source mode, range =
2.04 mA
–
33
100
µA
Slow mode, sink mode, range =
31.875 µA
–
36
100
µA
Slow mode, sink mode, range =
255 µA
–
33
100
µA
Slow mode, sink mode, range =
2.04 mA
–
33
100
µA
Fast mode, source mode, range =
31.875 µA
–
310
500
µA
Fast mode, source mode, range =
255 µA
–
305
500
µA
Fast mode, source mode, range =
2.04 mA
–
305
500
µA
Fast mode, sink mode, range =
31.875 µA
–
310
500
µA
Fast mode, sink mode, range =
255 µA
–
300
500
µA
Fast mode, sink mode, range =
2.04 mA
–
300
500
µA
Note
56. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 90 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
Figure 11-41. IDAC INL vs Input Code, Range = 255 µA,
Source Mode
Figure 11-42. IDAC INL vs Input Code, Range = 255 µA, Sink
Mode
1.5
1
INL,, LSB
0.5
0
-0.5
-1
-1.5
0
32
64
96
128
160
192
224
256
Code, 8-bit
Figure 11-43. IDAC DNL vs Input Code, Range = 255 µA,
Source Mode
Figure 11-44. IDAC DNL vs Input Code, Range = 255 µA, Sink
Mode
Figure 11-45. IDAC INL vs Temperature, Range = 255 µA,
Fast Mode
Figure 11-46. IDAC DNL vs Temperature, Range = 255 µA,
Fast Mode
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 91 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-47. IDAC Full Scale Error vs Temperature, Range
= 255 µA, Source Mode
Figure 11-48. IDAC Full Scale Error vs Temperature, Range
= 255 µA, Sink Mode
Figure 11-49. IDAC Operating Current vs Temperature,
Range = 255 µA, Code = 0, Source Mode
Figure 11-50. IDAC Operating Current vs Temperature,
Range = 255 µA, Code = 0, Sink Mode
Table 11-35. IDAC AC Specifications[57]
Parameter
FDAC
TSETTLE
Description
Update rate
Settling time to 0.5 LSB
Current noise
Conditions
Range = 31.875 µA, full scale
transition, fast mode, 600 Ω 15-pF
load
Range = 255 µA, full scale
transition, fast mode, 600 Ω 15-pF
load
Range = 255 µA, source mode, fast
mode, Vdda = 5 V, 10 kHz
Min
–
–
Typ
–
–
Max
8
125
Units
Msps
ns
–
–
125
ns
–
340
–
pA/sqrtHz
Note
57. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 92 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
Figure 11-51. IDAC Step Response, Codes 0x40 - 0xC0,
255 µA Mode, Source Mode, Fast Mode, Vdda = 5 V
Figure 11-52. IDAC Glitch Response, Codes 0x7F - 0x80,
255 µA Mode, Source Mode, Fast Mode, Vdda = 5 V
Figure 11-53. IDAC PSRR vs Frequency
Figure 11-54. IDAC Current Noise, 255 µA Mode,
Source Mode, Fast Mode, Vdda = 5 V
60
100000
Current Noise is proportional to Scale * Code
40
10000
30
pA
A/sqrtHz
PSRR, dB
P
50
20
10
1000
100
0
0.1
1
10
100
1000
10000
10
Frequency, kHz
255 ȝA, code 0x7F
0.01
255 ȝA, code 0xFF
0.1
1
10
Frequency, kHz
Code 0xFF
100
1000
Code 0x40
11.5.8 Voltage Digital to Analog Converter (VDAC)
See the VDAC component datasheet in PSoC Creator for full electrical specifications and APIs.
Unless otherwise specified, all charts and graphs show typical values.
Table 11-36. VDAC DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Resolution
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
8
–
bits
INL1
Integral nonlinearity
1 V scale
–
±2.1
±2.5
LSB
INL4
Integral nonlinearity[58]
4 V scale
–
±2.1
±2.5
LSB
DNL1
Differential nonlinearity
1 V scale
–
±0.3
±1
LSB
DNL4
Differential nonlinearity[58]
4 V scale
–
±0.3
±1
LSB
Rout
Output resistance
VOUT
Output voltage range, code = 255
1 V scale
–
4
–
kΩ
4 V scale
–
16
–
kΩ
1 V scale
–
1.02
–
V
4 V scale, Vdda = 5 V
–
4.08
–
V
Note
58. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 93 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 11-36. VDAC DC Specifications (continued)
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Monotonicity
–
–
Yes
–
VOS
Zero scale error
–
0
±0.9
LSB
Eg
Gain error
1 V scale
–
–
±2.5
%
4 V scale
–
–
±2.5
%
TC_Eg
IDD
Temperature coefficient, gain error 1 V scale
–
–
0.03
%FSR / °C
4 V scale
–
–
0.03
%FSR / °C
Slow mode
–
–
100
µA
Fast mode
–
–
500
µA
Operating current[59]
Figure 11-55. VDAC INL vs Input Code, 1 V Mode
Figure 11-56. VDAC DNL vs Input Code, 1 V Mode
Figure 11-57. VDAC INL vs Temperature, 1 V Mode
Figure 11-58. VDAC DNL vs Temperature, 1 V Mode
Note
59. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 94 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-59. VDAC Full Scale Error vs Temperature, 1 V
Mode
Figure 11-60. VDAC Full Scale Error vs Temperature, 4 V
Mode
Figure 11-61. VDAC Operating Current vs Temperature, 1V
Mode, Slow Mode
Figure 11-62. VDAC Operating Current vs Temperature, 1 V
Mode, Fast Mode
Table 11-37. VDAC AC Specifications[60]
Parameter
FDAC
Description
Update rate
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
1 V scale
–
–
1000
ksps
4 V scale
–
–
250
ksps
–
0.45
1
µs
TsettleP
Settling time to 0.1%, step 25% to 1 V scale, Cload = 15 pF
75%
4 V scale, Cload = 15 pF
–
0.8
3.2
µs
TsettleN
Settling time to 0.1%, step 75% to 1 V scale, Cload = 15 pF
25%
–
0.45
1
µs
4 V scale, Cload = 15 pF
–
0.7
3
µs
Range = 1 V, fast mode, Vdda =
5 V, 10 kHz
–
750
–
nV/sqrtHz
Voltage noise
Note
60. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 95 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
Figure 11-63. VDAC Step Response, Codes 0x40 - 0xC0, 1 V
Mode, Fast Mode, Vdda = 5 V
Figure 11-64. VDAC Glitch Response, Codes 0x7F - 0x80,
1 V Mode, Fast Mode, Vdda = 5 V
1
0.8
Vou
ut, V
0.6
0.4
0.2
0
0
0.5
1
Time, μs
1.5
2
Figure 11-65. VDAC PSRR vs Frequency
Figure 11-66. VDAC Voltage Noise, 1 V Mode, Fast Mode,
Vdda = 5 V
50
100000
40
20
nV/sqrrtHz
PSRR, dB
P
Voltage Noise is proportional to Scale * Code
10000
30
10
1000
100
0
0.1
1
10
Frequency, kHz
4 V, code 0x7F
100
4 V, code 0xFF
1000
10
0.01
0.1
1
10
Frequency, kHz
Code 0xFF
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
100
1000
Code 0x40
Page 96 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.5.9 Mixer
The mixer is created using a SC/CT analog block; see the Mixer component datasheet in PSoC Creator for full electrical specifications
and APIs.
Table 11-38. Mixer DC Specifications
Parameter
VOS
G
Description
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
–
15
mV
Quiescent current
–
0.9
2
mA
Gain
–
0
–
dB
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
–
4
MHz
Input offset voltage
Conditions
High power mode, VIN = 1.024 V,
VREF = 1.024 V
Table 11-39. Mixer AC Specifications[61]
Parameter
Description
Conditions
fLO
Local oscillator frequency
fin
Input signal frequency
Down mixer mode
–
–
14
MHz
fLO
Local oscillator frequency
Up mixer mode
–
–
1
MHz
fin
Input signal frequency
Up mixer mode
SR
Slew rate
Down mixer mode
–
–
1
MHz
3
–
–
V/µs
11.5.10 Transimpedance Amplifier
The TIA is created using a SC/CT analog block; see the TIA component datasheet in PSoC Creator for full electrical specifications
and APIs.
Table 11-40. Transimpedance Amplifier (TIA) DC Specifications
Parameter
VIOFF
Rconv
Description
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
–
10
mV
R = 20K; 40 pF load
–25
–
+35
%
R = 30K; 40 pF load
–25
–
+35
%
R = 40K; 40 pF load
–25
–
+35
%
R = 80K; 40 pF load
–25
–
+35
%
R = 120K; 40 pF load
–25
–
+35
%
R = 250K; 40 pF load
–25
–
+35
%
R= 500K; 40 pF load
–25
–
+35
%
R = 1M; 40 pF load
–25
–
+35
%
–
1.1
2
mA
Input offset voltage
Conversion
Quiescent
resistance[62]
current[61]
Table 11-41. Transimpedance Amplifier (TIA) AC Specifications[61]
Parameter
BW
Description
Input bandwidth (–3 dB)
Min
Typ
Max
Units
R = 20K; –40 pF load
Conditions
1200
–
–
kHz
R = 120K; –40 pF load
240
–
–
kHz
R = 1M; –40 pF load
25
–
–
kHz
Notes
61. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
62. Conversion resistance values are not calibrated. Calibrated values and details about calibration are provided in PSoC Creator component datasheets. External precision
resistors can also be used.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 97 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.5.11 Programmable Gain Amplifier
The PGA is created using a SC/CT analog block; see the PGA component datasheet in PSoC Creator for full electrical specifications
and APIs.
Unless otherwise specified, operating conditions are:
■
Operating temperature = 25 °C for typical values
■
Unless otherwise specified, all charts and graphs show typical values
Table 11-42. PGA DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Vssa
–
Vdda
V
Power mode = high,
gain = 1
–
–
10
mV
Power mode = high,
gain = 1
–
–
±30
µV/°C
Vin
Input voltage range
Power mode = minimum
Vos
Input offset voltage
TCVos
Input offset voltage drift
with temperature
Ge1
Gain error, gain = 1
–
–
±0.15
%
Ge16
Gain error, gain = 16
–
–
±2.5
%
Ge50
Gain error, gain = 50
–
–
±5
%
Vonl
DC output nonlinearity
–
–
±0.01
% of
FSR
Cin
Input capacitance
–
–
7
pF
Voh
Output voltage swing
Power mode = high,
gain = 1, Rload = 100 kΩ
to VDDA / 2
VDDA – 0.15
–
–
V
Vol
Output voltage swing
Power mode = high,
gain = 1, Rload = 100 kΩ
to VDDA / 2
–
–
VSSA + 0.15
V
Vsrc
Output voltage under load
Iload = 250 µA, Vdda ≥
2.7V, power mode = high
–
–
300
mV
Idd
Operating current[63]
Power mode = high
–
1.5
1.65
mA
PSRR
Power supply rejection
ratio
48
–
–
dB
Gain = 1
Figure 11-67. PGA Voffset Histogram, 4096 samples/
1024 parts
Note
63. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 98 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
Table 11-43. PGA AC Specifications[64]
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
6.7
8
–
MHz
Power mode = high,
gain = 1, 20% to 80%
3
–
–
V/µs
Power mode = high,
Vdda = 5 V, at 100 kHz
–
43
–
nV/sqrtHz
BW1
–3 dB bandwidth
Power mode = high,
gain = 1, input = 100 mV
peak-to-peak
SR1
Slew rate
en
Input noise density
Figure 11-68. Bandwidth vs. Temperature, at Different Gain
Settings, Power Mode = High
Figure 11-69. Noise vs. Frequency, Vdda = 5 V,
Power Mode = High
1000
nV/sq
qrtHz
BW, MHz
10
1
100
0.1
-40
-20
0
20
40
60
10
80
0.01
Temperature, °C
Gain = 1
Gain = 24
0.1
Gain = 48
1
10
Frequency, kHz
100
1000
11.5.12 Temperature Sensor
Table 11-44. Temperature Sensor Specifications
Parameter
Description
Temp sensor accuracy
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
±5
–
°C
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Range: –40 °C to +85 °C
11.5.13 LCD Direct Drive
Table 11-43. LCD Direct Drive DC Specifications[64]
Parameter
Description
ICC
LCD Block (no glass)
Device sleep mode with wakeup at
400Hz rate to refresh LCD, bus, clock =
3MHz, Vddio = Vdda = 3V, 8 commons,
16 segments, 1/5 duty cycle, 40 Hz
frame rate, no glass connected
–
81
–
μA
ICC_SEG
Current per segment driver
Strong drive mode
–
260
–
µA
VBIAS
LCD bias range (VBIAS refers to the VDDA ≥ 3 V and VDDA ≥ VBIAS
main output voltage(V0) of LCD DAC)
2
–
5
V
IOUT
LCD bias step size
VDDA ≥ 3 V and VDDA ≥ VBIAS
–
9.1 × VDDA
–
mV
LCD capacitance per segment/
common driver
Drivers may be combined
–
500
5000
pF
Maximum segment DC offset
VDDA ≥ 3 V and VDDA ≥ VBIAS
–
–
20
mV
Output drive current per segment
driver)
VDDIO = 5.5 V, strong drive mode
355
–
710
µA
Note
64. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 99 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 11-44. LCD Direct Drive AC Specifications
Parameter
fLCD
Description
LCD frame rate
Conditions
Min
10
Typ
50
Max
150
Units
Hz
11.6 Digital Peripherals
Specifications are valid for –40 °C ≤ TA ≤ 85 °C and TJ ≤ 100 °C, except where noted. Specifications are valid for 1.71 V to 5.5 V,
except where noted.
11.6.1 Timer
The following specifications apply to the Timer/Counter/PWM peripheral in timer mode. Timers can also be implemented in UDBs; for
more information, see the Timer component datasheet in PSoC Creator.
Table 11-45. Timer DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Block current consumption
Conditions
16-bit timer, at listed input clock
frequency
3 MHz
12 MHz
48 MHz
67 MHz
Min
–
Typ
–
Max
–
Units
µA
–
–
–
–
15
60
260
350
–
–
–
–
µA
µA
µA
µA
Min
DC
15
30
15
15
30
15
30
Typ
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
Max
67.01
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
Units
MHz
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
Table 11-46. Timer AC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Operating frequency
Capture pulse width (Internal)[65]
Capture pulse width (external)
Timer resolution[65]
Enable pulse width[65]
Enable pulse width (external)
Reset pulse width[65]
Reset pulse width (external)
Conditions
11.6.2 Counter
The following specifications apply to the Timer/Counter/PWM peripheral, in counter mode. Counters can also be implemented in
UDBs; for more information, see the Counter component datasheet in PSoC Creator.
Table 11-47. Counter DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Block current consumption
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
16-bit counter, at listed input clock
frequency
–
–
–
µA
3 MHz
–
15
–
µA
12 MHz
–
60
–
µA
48 MHz
–
260
–
µA
67 MHz
–
350
–
µA
Note
65. For correct operation, the minimum Timer/Counter/PWM input pulse width is the period of bus clock.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 100 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 11-48. Counter AC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Operating frequency
Capture pulse[66]
Resolution[66]
Pulse width[66]
Pulse width (external)
Enable pulse width[66]
Enable pulse width (external)
Reset pulse width[66]
Reset pulse width (external)
Conditions
Min
DC
15
15
15
30
15
30
15
30
Typ
–
–
–
–
Max
67.01
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
Units
MHz
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
11.6.3 Pulse Width Modulation
The following specifications apply to the Timer/Counter/PWM peripheral, in PWM mode. PWM components can also be implemented
in UDBs; for more information, see the PWM component datasheet in PSoC Creator.
Table 11-49. PWM DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Block current consumption
Conditions
16-bit PWM, at listed input clock
frequency
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
–
–
µA
3 MHz
–
15
–
µA
12 MHz
–
60
–
µA
48 MHz
–
260
–
µA
67 MHz
–
350
–
µA
Min
Typ
Max
Units
DC
–
67.01
MHz
Table 11-50. PWM AC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Operating frequency
width[66]
15
–
–
ns
Pulse width (external)
30
–
–
ns
Pulse
Kill pulse width[66]
15
–
–
ns
Kill pulse width (external)
30
–
–
ns
Enable pulse width[66]
15
–
–
ns
Enable pulse width (external)
30
–
–
ns
Reset pulse width[66]
15
–
–
ns
Reset pulse width (external)
30
–
–
ns
Min
Typ
Max
Units
11.6.4 I2C
Table 11-51. Fixed I2C DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Block current consumption
Conditions
Enabled, configured for 100 kbps
–
–
250
µA
Enabled, configured for 400 kbps
–
–
260
µA
Note
66. For correct operation, the minimum Timer/Counter/PWM input pulse width is the period of bus clock.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 101 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 11-52. Fixed I2C AC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Bit rate
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
–
1
Mbps
Typ
–
Max
200
11.6.5 Controller Area Network[67]
Table 11-55. CAN DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Block current consumption
IDD
Conditions
Min
–
Units
µA
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
–
1
Mbit
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
0.16
0.27
mA
1 MHz (13.4 ksps)
–
0.33
0.53
mA
10 MHz (134 ksps)
–
3.3
5.3
mA
48 MHz (644 ksps)
–
15.7
25.5
mA
67 MHz (900 ksps)
–
21.8
35.6
mA
Min
Typ
Max
Units
DC
–
67.01
MHz
Table 11-56. CAN AC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Bit rate
Minimum 8 MHz clock
11.6.6 Digital Filter Block
Table 11-57. DFB DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
DFB operating current
Conditions
64-tap FIR at FDFB
500 kHz (6.7 ksps)
Table 11-58. DFB AC Specifications
Parameter
FDFB
Description
DFB operating frequency
Conditions
Note
67. Refer to ISO 11898 specification for details.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 102 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.6.7 USB
Table 11-59. USB DC Specifications
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
Units
USB configured, USB regulator
enabled
4.35
–
5.25
V
VUSB_3.3
USB configured, USB regulator
bypassed
3.15
–
3.6
V
VUSB_3
USB configured, USB regulator
bypassed[68]
2.85
–
3.6
V
VUSB_5
Description
Device supply for USB operation
Conditions
IUSB_Configured Device supply current in device active VDDD = 5 V, FCPU = 1.5 MHz
mode, bus clock and IMO = 24 MHz V
DDD = 3.3 V, FCPU = 1.5 MHz
–
10
–
mA
–
8
–
mA
–
0.5
–
mA
VDDD = 5 V, disconnected from
USB host
–
0.3
–
mA
VDDD = 3.3 V, connected to USB
host, PICU configured to wake on
USB resume signal
–
0.5
–
mA
VDDD = 3.3 V, disconnected from
USB host
–
0.3
–
mA
IUSB_Suspended Device supply current in device sleep VDDD = 5 V, connected to USB
mode
host, PICU configured to wake on
USB resume signal
11.6.8 Universal Digital Blocks (UDBs)
PSoC Creator provides a library of pre-built and tested standard digital peripherals (UART, SPI, LIN, PRS, CRC, timer, counter, PWM,
AND, OR, and so on) that are mapped to the UDB array. See the component datasheets in PSoC Creator for full AC/DC specifications,
APIs, and example code.
Table 11-60. UDB AC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
FMAX_TIMER Maximum frequency of 16-bit timer in
a UDB pair
–
–
67.01
MHz
FMAX_ADDER Maximum frequency of 16-bit adder in
a UDB pair
–
–
67.01
MHz
–
–
67.01
MHz
–
–
67.01
MHz
Datapath Performance
FMAX_CRC
Maximum frequency of 16-bit
CRC/PRS in a UDB pair
PLD Performance
FMAX_PLD
Maximum frequency of a two-pass
PLD function in a UDB pair
Clock to Output Performance
tCLK_OUT
Propagation delay for clock in to data 25 °C, Vddd ≥ 2.7 V
out, see Figure 11-70.
–
20
25
ns
tCLK_OUT
Propagation delay for clock in to data Worst-case placement, routing,
out, see Figure 11-70.
and pin selection
–
–
55
ns
Note
68. Rise/fall time matching (TR) not guaranteed, see USB Driver AC Specifications[37] on page 76.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 103 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-70. Clock to Output Performance
11.7 Memory
Specifications are valid for –40 °C ≤ TA ≤ 85 °C and TJ ≤ 100 °C, except where noted. Specifications are valid for 1.71 V to 5.5 V,
except where noted.
11.7.1 Flash
Table 11-61. Flash DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Erase and program voltage
Conditions
VDDD pin
Min
Typ
Max
Units
1.71
–
5.5
V
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Table 11-62. Flash AC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Conditions
TWRITE
Row write time (erase + program)
–
15
20
ms
TERASE
Row erase time
–
10
13
ms
Row program time
–
5
7
ms
Bulk erase time (256 KB)
–
–
140
ms
TBULK
Sector erase time (16 KB)
TPROG
–
–
15
ms
Total device programming time
No overhead[69]
–
5
7.5
seconds
Flash data retention time, retention
period measured from last erase cycle
Average ambient temp.
TA ≤ 55 °C, 100 K erase/
program cycles
20
–
–
years
Average ambient temp.
TA ≤ 85 °C, 10 K erase/
program cycles
10
–
–
Note
69. See PSoC 5 Device Programming Specifications for a description of a low-overhead method of programming PSoC 5 flash.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 104 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.7.2 EEPROM
Table 11-63. EEPROM DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Erase and program voltage
Min
Typ
Max
Units
1.71
–
5.5
V
Table 11-64. EEPROM AC Specifications
Parameter
TWRITE
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Single row erase/write cycle time
Description
Conditions
–
10
20
ms
EEPROM data retention time, retention Average ambient temp, TA ≤ 25 °C,
period measured from last erase cycle 1M erase/program cycles
20
–
–
years
Average ambient temp, TA ≤ 55 °C,
100 K erase/program cycles
20
–
–
Average ambient temp. TA ≤ 85 °C,
10 K erase/program cycles
10
–
–
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
1.71
–
5.5
V
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Programmed at 25 °C
1K
–
–
program/
erase
cycles
Programmed at 0 °C to 70 °C
100
–
–
program/
erase
cycles
11.7.3 Nonvolatile Latches (NVL)
Table 11-65. NVL DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Erase and program voltage
VDDD pin
Table 11-66. NVL AC Specifications
Parameter
Description
NVL endurance
NVL data retention time
Conditions
Average ambient temp. TA ≤ 55 °C
20
–
–
years
Average ambient temp. TA ≤ 85 °C
10
–
–
years
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
1.2
–
–
V
Min
Typ
Max
Units
DC
–
67.01
MHz
11.7.4 SRAM
Table 11-67. SRAM DC Specifications
Parameter
VSRAM
Description
SRAM retention voltage
Table 11-68. SRAM AC Specifications
Parameter
FSRAM
Description
SRAM operating frequency
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Conditions
Page 105 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.7.5 External Memory Interface
Figure 11-71. Asynchronous Write and Read Cycle Timing, No Wait States
Tbus_clock
Bus Clock
EM_Addr
EM_CE
EM_WE
EM_OE
Twr_setup
Trd_hold
Trd_setup
EM_Data
Write Cycle
Read Cycle
Minimum of 4 bus clock cycles between successive EMIF accesses
Table 11-69. Asynchronous Write and Read Timing Specifications
Parameter
Description
Bus clock
frequency[70]
Tbus_clock
Bus clock
period[71]
Twr_Setup
Time from EM_data valid to rising edge of
EM_WE and EM_CE
Trd_setup
Trd_hold
Fbus_clock
Conditions
Min
Typ[26]
Max
Units
–
–
33
MHz
30.3
–
–
ns
Tbus_clock – 10
–
–
ns
Time that EM_data must be valid before rising
edge of EM_OE
5
–
–
ns
Time that EM_data must be valid after rising
edge of EM_OE
5
–
–
ns
Notes
70. EMIF signal timings are limited by GPIO frequency limitations. See “GPIO” section on page 69.
71. EMIF output signals are generally synchronized to bus clock, so EMIF signal timings are dependent on bus clock frequency.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 106 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 11-72. Synchronous Write and Read Cycle Timing, No Wait States
Tbus_clock
Bus Clock
EM_Clock
EM_Addr
EM_CE
EM_ADSC
EM_WE
EM_OE
Twr_setup
Trd_hold
Trd_setup
EM_Data
Write Cycle
Read Cycle
Minimum of 4 bus clock cycles between successive EMIF accesses
Table 11-70. Synchronous Write and Read Timing Specifications
Parameter
Fbus_clock
Description
Bus clock
frequency[72]
period[73]
Tbus_clock
Bus clock
Twr_Setup
Time from EM_data valid to rising edge of
EM_Clock
Trd_setup
Trd_hold
Conditions
Min
Typ[26]
Max
Units
–
–
33
MHz
30.3
–
–
ns
Tbus_clock – 10
–
–
ns
Time that EM_data must be valid before rising
edge of EM_OE
5
–
–
ns
Time that EM_data must be valid after rising
edge of EM_OE
5
–
–
ns
Notes
72. EMIF signal timings are limited by GPIO frequency limitations. See “GPIO” section on page 69.
73. EMIF output signals are generally synchronized to bus clock, so EMIF signal timings are dependent on bus clock frequency.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 107 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.8 PSoC System Resources
Specifications are valid for –40 °C ≤ TA ≤ 85 °C and TJ ≤ 100 °C, except where noted. Specifications are valid for 1.71 V to 5.5 V,
except where noted.
11.8.1 POR with Brown Out
For brown out detect in regulated mode, VDDD and VDDA must be ≥ 2.0 V. Brown out detect is not available in externally regulated
mode.
Table 11-71. Precise Low-Voltage Reset (PRES) with Brown Out DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
PRESR
Rising trip voltage
PRESF
Falling trip voltage
Conditions
Factory trim
Min
Typ
Max
Units
1.64
–
1.68
V
1.62
–
1.66
V
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Table 11-72. Power-On-Reset (POR) with Brown Out AC Specifications
Parameter
PRES_TR[74]
Description
Conditions
Response time
–
–
0.5
µs
–
5
–
V/sec
Min
Typ
Max
Units
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 0000b
1.68
1.73
1.77
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 0001b
1.89
1.95
2.01
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 0010b
2.14
2.20
2.27
V
VDDD/VDDA droop rate
Sleep mode
11.8.2 Voltage Monitors
Table 11-73. Voltage Monitors DC Specifications
Parameter
LVI
Description
Conditions
Trip voltage
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 0011b
2.38
2.45
2.53
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 0100b
2.62
2.71
2.79
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 0101b
2.87
2.95
3.04
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 0110b
3.11
3.21
3.31
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 0111b
3.35
3.46
3.56
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 1000b
3.59
3.70
3.81
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 1001b
3.84
3.95
4.07
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 1010b
4.08
4.20
4.33
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 1011b
4.32
4.45
4.59
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 1100b
4.56
4.70
4.84
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 1101b
4.83
4.98
5.13
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 1110b
5.05
5.21
5.37
V
LVI_A/D_SEL[3:0] = 1111b
HVI
Trip voltage
5.30
5.47
5.63
V
5.57
5.75
5.92
V
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
–
1
µs
Table 11-74. Voltage Monitors AC Specifications
Parameter
LVI_tr[74]
Description
Response time
Conditions
Note
74. This value is calculated, not measured.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 108 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
11.8.3 Interrupt Controller
Table 11-75. Interrupt Controller AC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Delay from interrupt signal input to ISR
code execution from main line code[75]
–
–
12
Tcy CPU
Delay from interrupt signal input to ISR
code execution from ISR code
(tail-chaining)[75]
–
–
6
Tcy CPU
11.8.4 JTAG Interface
Figure 11-73. JTAG Interface Timing
(1/f_TCK)
TCK
T_TDI_setup
T_TDI_hold
TDI
T_TDO_valid
T_TDO_hold
TDO
T_TMS_setup
T_TMS_hold
TMS
Table 11-76. JTAG Interface AC Specifications[76]
Parameter
f_TCK
Description
TCK frequency
Conditions
3.3 V ≤ VDDD ≤ 5 V
1.71 V ≤ VDDD < 3.3 V
T_TDI_setup
TDI setup before TCK high
T_TMS_setup
TMS setup before TCK high
T_TDI_hold
TDI, TMS hold after TCK high
T = 1/f_TCK max
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
–
12[77]
MHz
–
–
7[77]
MHz
(T/10) – 5
–
–
ns
T/4
–
–
T/4
–
–
T_TDO_valid
TCK low to TDO valid
T = 1/f_TCK max
–
–
2T/5
T_TDO_hold
TDO hold after TCK high
T = 1/f_TCK max
T/4
–
–
T_nTRST
Minimum nTRST pulse width
f_TCK = 2 MHz
8
–
–
ns
Notes
75. ARM Cortex-M3 NVIC spec. Visit www.arm.com for detailed documentation about the Cortex-M3 CPU.
76. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
77. f_TCK must also be no more than 1/3 CPU clock frequency.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 109 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.8.5 SWD Interface
Figure 11-74. SWD Interface Timing
(1/f_S W D C K )
SW DCK
T_SW D I_setup T_S W D I_hold
S W D IO
(P S oC input)
T_S W D O _valid
T_S W D O _hold
S W D IO
(P S oC output)
Table 11-77. SWD Interface AC Specifications[79]
Parameter
f_SWDCK
Description
SWDCLK frequency
Conditions
3.3 V ≤ VDDD ≤ 5 V
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
–
12[81]
MHz
MHz
MHz
1.71 V ≤ VDDD < 3.3 V
–
–
7[81]
1.71 V ≤ VDDD < 3.3 V, SWD over
USBIO pins
–
–
5.5[81]
T_SWDI_setup SWDIO input setup before SWDCK high T = 1/f_SWDCK max
T/4
–
–
T_SWDI_hold
T = 1/f_SWDCK max
T/4
–
–
T = 1/f_SWDCK max
–
–
T/2
T_SWDO_hold SWDIO output hold after SWDCK high T = 1/f_SWDCK max
1
–
–
ns
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
–
33[82]
MHz
–
33[82]
Mbit
SWDIO input hold after SWDCK high
T_SWDO_valid SWDCK high to SWDIO output
11.8.6 TPIU Interface
Table 11-78. TPIU Interface AC Specifications[79]
Parameter
Description
TRACEPORT (TRACECLK) frequency
SWV bit rate
Conditions
–
Notes
78. ARM Cortex-M3 NVIC spec. Visit www.arm.com for detailed documentation about the Cortex-M3 CPU.
79. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
80. f_TCK must also be no more than 1/3 CPU clock frequency.
81. f_SWDCK must also be no more than 1/3 CPU clock frequency.
82. TRACEPORT signal frequency and bit rate are limited by GPIO output frequency, see “GPIO AC Specifications[31]” on page 70.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 110 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.9 Clocking
Specifications are valid for –40 °C ≤ TA ≤ 85 °C and TJ ≤ 100 °C, except where noted. Specifications are valid for 1.71 V to 5.5 V,
except where noted. Unless otherwise specified, all charts and graphs show typical values
11.9.1 Internal Main Oscillator
Table 11-79. IMO DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
62.6 MHz
–
–
600
µA
48 MHz
–
–
500
µA
–
–
500
µA
–
–
300
µA
Supply current
Icc_imo
24 MHz – USB mode
With oscillator locking to USB bus
24 MHz – non-USB mode
12 MHz
–
–
200
µA
6 MHz
–
–
180
µA
3 MHz
–
–
150
µA
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–7
–
7
%
48 MHz
–5
–
5
%
24 MHz – non-USB mode
–4
–
4
%
Figure 11-75. IMO Current vs. Frequency
Table 11-80. IMO AC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Conditions
IMO frequency stability (with factory trim)
62.6 MHz
FIMO
24 MHz – USB mode
–0.25
–
0.25
%
12 MHz
–3
–
3
%
6 MHz
–2
–
2
%
3 MHz
–1
–
1
%
–
–
13
µs
Tstart_imo Startup
time[83]
With oscillator locking to USB bus
From enable (during normal system
operation)
Note
83. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 111 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 11-80. IMO AC Specifications (continued)
Parameter
Description
Min
Typ
Max
Units
F = 24 MHz
–
0.9
–
ns
F = 3 MHz
–
1.6
–
ns
F = 24 MHz
–
0.9
–
ns
F = 3 MHz
–
12
–
ns
Jitter (peak to
Jp-p
Conditions
peak)[84]
Jitter (long term)[85]
Jperiod
Figure 11-76. IMO Frequency Variation vs. Temperature
Figure 11-77. IMO Frequency Variation vs. VCC
Note
84. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
85. Based on device characterization (Not production tested). USBIO pins tied to ground (VSSD).
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 112 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
11.0.1 Internal Low-Speed Oscillator
Table 11-81. ILO DC Specifications
Parameter
Description
Operating
Conditions
current[86]
Min
Typ
Max
Units
FOUT = 1 kHz
–
–
1.7
µA
FOUT = 33 kHz
–
–
2.6
µA
FOUT = 100 kHz
–
–
2.6
µA
Power down mode
–
–
15
nA
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
–
2
ms
100 kHz
45
100
200
kHz
1 kHz
0.5
1
2
kHz
100 kHz
30
100
300
kHz
1 kHz
0.3
1
3.5
kHz
ICC
Leakage current[86]
Table 11-82. ILO AC Specifications
Parameter
Tstart_ilo
Description
Conditions
Startup time, all frequencies
Turbo mode
ILO frequencies (trimmed)
FILO
ILO frequencies (untrimmed)
Figure 11-78. ILO Frequency Variation vs. Temperature
Figure 11-79. ILO Frequency Variation vs. VDD
50
20
10
% Variiation
% Variiation
25
0
100 kHz
-25
0
100 kHz
-10
1 kHz
1 kHz
-50
-20
-40
-20
0
20
40
Temperature, °C
60
80
1.5
2.5
3.5
4.5
5.5
VDDD, V
Note
86. This value is calculated, not measured.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 113 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
11.9.4 MHz External Crystal Oscillator
For more information on crystal or ceramic resonator selection for the MHzECO, refer to application note AN54439: PSoC 3 and
PSoC 5 External Oscillators.
Table 11-83. MHzECO AC Specifications
Parameter
F
Description
Conditions
Crystal frequency range
Min
Typ
Max
Units
4
–
25
MHz
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
0.25
1.0
µA
–
–
1
µW
Min
Typ
Max
Units
–
32.768
–
kHz
–
1
–
s
Min
Typ
11.9.5 kHz External Crystal Oscillator
Table 11-84. kHzECO DC Specifications[83]
Parameter
Description
ICC
Operating current
DL
Drive level
Conditions
Low power mode; CL = 6 pF
Table 11-85. kHzECO AC Specifications
Parameter
Description
F
Frequency
TON
Startup time
Conditions
High power mode
11.9.6 External Clock Reference
Table 11-86. External Clock Reference AC Specifications[87]
Parameter
Description
Conditions
External frequency range
Max
Units
0
–
33
MHz
Input duty cycle range
Measured at VDDIO/2
30
50
70
%
Input edge rate
VIL to VIH
0.5
–
–
V/ns
11.9.7 Phase-Locked Loop
Table 11-87. PLL DC Specifications
Parameter
IDD
Description
PLL operating current
Min
Typ
Max
Units
In = 3 MHz, Out = 67 MHz
Conditions
–
400
–
µA
In = 3 MHz, Out = 24 MHz
–
200
–
µA
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Table 11-88. PLL AC Specifications
Parameter
Fpllin
Description
PLL input
1
–
48
MHz
1
–
3
MHz
PLL output frequency[88]
24
–
67
MHz
Lock time at startup
–
–
250
µs
(rms)[87]
–
–
250
ps
PLL intermediate frequency[89]
Fpllout
Conditions
frequency[88]
Jperiod-rms Jitter
Output of prescaler
Notes
87. Based on device characterization (Not production tested).
88. This specification is guaranteed by testing the PLL across the specified range using the IMO as the source for the PLL.
89. PLL input divider, Q, must be set so that the input frequency is divided down to the intermediate frequency range. Value for Q ranges from 1 to 16.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 114 of 122
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
PRELIMINARY
12. Ordering Information
In addition to the features listed in Table 12-1, every CY8C58LP device includes: up to 256 KB flash, 64 KB SRAM, 2 KB EEPROM,
a precision on-chip voltage reference, precision oscillators, flash, ECC, DMA, a fixed function I2C, JTAG/SWD programming and
debug, external memory interface, boost, and more. In addition to these features, the flexible UDBs and analog subsection support
a wide range of peripherals. To assist you in selecting the ideal part, PSoC Creator makes a part recommendation after you choose
the components required by your application. All CY8C58LP derivatives incorporate device and flash security in user-selectable
security levels; see the TRM for details.
Table 12-1. CY8C58LP Family with ARM Cortex-M3 CPU
Analog
I/O[92]
16-bit Timer/PWM
FS USB
CAN 2.0b
SIO
USBIO
0
100-TQFP
0x2E11F069
CY8C5868AXI-LP032 67 256 64
2
✔ 1x20-bit Del-Sig 4
2x12-bit SAR
4
4
4 ✔ ✔ 24 4
✔
– 72 62 8
2
100-TQFP
0x2E120069
CY8C5868AXI-LP035 67 256 64
2
✔ 1x20-bit Del-Sig 4
2x12-bit SAR
4
4
4 ✔ ✔ 24 4
✔
✔ 72 62 8
2
100-TQFP
0x2E123069
CY8C5868LTI-LP036
67 256 64
2
✔ 1x20-bit Del-Sig 4
2x12-bit SAR
4
4
2 ✔ ✔ 24 4
–
– 46 38 8
0
68-QFN
0x2E124069
CY8C5868LTI-LP038
67 256 64
2
✔ 1x20-bit Del-Sig 4
2x12-bit SAR
4
4
2 ✔ ✔ 24 4
✔
– 48 38 8
2
68-QFN
0x2E126069
CY8C5868LTI-LP039
67 256 64
2
✔ 1x20-bit Del-Sig 4
2x12-bit SAR
4
4
2 ✔ ✔ 24 4
✔
✔ 48 38 8
2
68-QFN
0x2E127069
CY8C5867AXI-LP023 67 128 32
2
✔ 1x20-bit Del-Sig 4
1x12-bit SAR
4
4
4 ✔ ✔ 24 4
–
– 70 62 8
0
100-TQFP
0x2E117069
CY8C5867AXI-LP024 67 128 32
2
✔ 1x20-bit Del-Sig 4
1x12-bit SAR
4
4
4 ✔ ✔ 24 4
✔
– 72 62 8
2
100-TQFP
0x2E118069
CY8C5867LTI-LP025
67 128 32
2
✔ 1x20-bit Del-Sig 4
1x12-bit SAR
4
4
2 ✔ ✔ 24 4
–
– 46 38 8
0
68-QFN
0x2E119069
CY8C5867LTI-LP028
67 128 32
2
✔ 1x20-bit Del-Sig 4
1x12-bit SAR
4
4
2 ✔ ✔ 24 4
✔
– 48 38 8
2
68-QFN
0x2E11C069
GPIO
Package
Total I/O
UDBs[91]
– 70 62 8
CapSense
–
DFB
4 ✔ ✔ 24 4
SC/CT
Analog Blocks[90]
Opamps
4
Comparators
4
DAC
✔ 1x20-bit Del-Sig 4
2x12-bit SAR
ADCs
2
Flash (KB)
CY8C5868AXI-LP031 67 256 64
Part Number
CPU Speed (MHz)
EEPROM (KB)
Digital
SRAM (KB)
LCD Segment Drive
MCU Core
JTAG ID[93]
CY8C5866AXI-LP020 67
64
16
2
✔ 1x20-bit Del-Sig 4
1x12-bit SAR
4
4
4 ✔ ✔ 20 4
✔
✔ 72 62 8
2
100-TQFP
0x2E114069
CY8C5866AXI-LP021 67
64
16
2
✔ 1x20-bit Del-Sig 4
1x12-bit SAR
4
4
4 ✔ ✔ 20 4
✔
– 72 62 8
2
100-TQFP
0x2E115069
CY8C5866LTI-LP022
64
16
2
✔ 1x20-bit Del-Sig 4
1x12-bit SAR
4
4
2 ✔ ✔ 20 4
✔
– 48 38 8
2
68-QFN
0x2E116069
67
Notes
90. Analog blocks support a wide variety of functionality including TIA, PGA, and mixers. See Example Peripherals on page 36 for more information on how analog blocks
can be used.
91. UDBs support a wide variety of functionality including SPI, LIN, UART, timer, counter, PWM, PRS, and others. Individual functions may use a fraction of a UDB or
multiple UDBs. Multiple functions can share a single UDB. See Example Peripherals on page 36 for more information on how UDBs can be used.
92. The I/O Count includes all types of digital I/O: GPIO, SIO, and the two USB I/O. See “I/O System and Routing” section on page 29 for details on the functionality of
each of these types of I/O.
93. The JTAG ID has three major fields. The most significant nibble (left digit) is the version, followed by a 2 byte part number and a 3 nibble manufacturer ID.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 115 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
12.1 Part Numbering Conventions
PSoC 5LP devices follow the part numbering convention described here. All fields are single character alphanumeric (0, 1, 2, …, 9,
A, B, …, Z) unless stated otherwise.
CY8Cabcdefg-LPxxx
■
a: Architecture
❐ 3: PSoC 3
❐ 5: PSoC 5
■
b: Family group within architecture
❐ 2: CY8C52LP family
❐ 4: CY8C54LP family
❐ 6: CY8C56LP family
❐ 8: CY8C58LP family
■
■
c: Speed grade
❐ 6: 67 MHz
d: Flash capacity
❐ 5: 32 KB
❐ 6: 64 KB
❐ 7: 128 KB
❐ 8: 256 KB
■
ef: Package code
❐ Two character alphanumeric
❐ AX: TQFP
❐ LT: QFN
❐ PV: SSOP
■
g: Temperature range
❐ C: commercial
❐ I: industrial
❐ A: automotive
■
xxx: Peripheral set
❐ Three character numeric
❐ No meaning is associated with these three characters
Examples
CY8C
5 8 6 8 AX/PV I - LPx x x
Cypress Prefix
5: PSoC 5
8: CY8C58LP Family
Architecture
Family Group within Architecture
6: 67 MHz
Speed Grade
8: 256 KB
Flash Capacity
AX: TQFP, PV: SSOP
Package Code
I: Industrial
Temperature Range
Peripheral Set
All devices in the PSoC 5LP CY8C58LP family comply to RoHS-6 specifications, demonstrating the commitment by Cypress to
lead-free products. Lead (Pb) is an alloying element in solders that has resulted in environmental concerns due to potential toxicity.
Cypress uses nickel-palladium-gold (NiPdAu) technology for the majority of leadframe-based packages.
A high level review of the Cypress Pb-free position is available on our website. Specific package information is also available. Package
Material Declaration Datasheets (PMDDs) identify all substances contained within Cypress packages. PMDDs also confirm the
absence of many banned substances. The information in the PMDDs will help Cypress customers plan for recycling or other “end of
life” requirements.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 116 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
13. Packaging
Table 13-1. Package Characteristics
Parameter
Description
Conditions
Min
Typ
Max
Units
TA
Operating ambient temperature
–40
25
85
°C
TJ
Operating junction temperature
–40
–
100
°C
TJA
Package θJA (68-pin QFN)
–
15
–
°C/Watt
TJA
Package θJA (100-pin TQFP)
–
34
–
°C/Watt
TJC
Package θJC (68-pin QFN)
–
13
–
°C/Watt
TJC
Package θJC (100-pin TQFP)
–
10
–
°C/Watt
Table 13-2. Solder Reflow Peak Temperature
Package
Maximum Peak
Temperature
Maximum Time at
Peak Temperature
68-pin QFN
260 °C
30 seconds
100-pin TQFP
260 °C
30 seconds
Table 13-3. Package Moisture Sensitivity Level (MSL), IPC/JEDEC J-STD-2
Package
MSL
68-pin QFN
MSL 3
100-pin TQFP
MSL 3
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 117 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Figure 13-1. 68-pin QFN 8x8 with 0.4 mm Pitch Package Outline (Sawn Version)
001-09618 *E
Figure 13-2. 100-pin TQFP (14 x 14 x 1.4 mm) Package Outline
51-85048 *G
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 118 of 122
PRELIMINARY
Table 14-1. Acronyms Used in this Document (continued)
14. Acronyms
Table 14-1. Acronyms Used in this Document
Acronym
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Description
Acronym
Description
FIR
finite impulse response, see also IIR
FPB
flash patch and breakpoint
FS
full-speed
GPIO
general-purpose input/output, applies to a PSoC
pin
HVI
high-voltage interrupt, see also LVI, LVD
abus
analog local bus
ADC
analog-to-digital converter
AG
analog global
AHB
AMBA (advanced microcontroller bus architecture) high-performance bus, an ARM data
transfer bus
IC
integrated circuit
ALU
arithmetic logic unit
IDAC
current DAC, see also DAC, VDAC
AMUXBUS
analog multiplexer bus
IDE
integrated development environment
application programming interface
I2C,
API
APSR
application program status register
ARM®
advanced RISC machine, a CPU architecture
ATM
automatic thump mode
BW
bandwidth
CAN
Controller Area Network, a communications
protocol
CMRR
or IIC
Inter-Integrated Circuit, a communications
protocol
IIR
infinite impulse response, see also FIR
ILO
internal low-speed oscillator, see also IMO
IMO
internal main oscillator, see also ILO
INL
integral nonlinearity, see also DNL
I/O
input/output, see also GPIO, DIO, SIO, USBIO
common-mode rejection ratio
IPOR
initial power-on reset
CPU
central processing unit
IPSR
interrupt program status register
CRC
cyclic redundancy check, an error-checking
protocol
IRQ
interrupt request
DAC
digital-to-analog converter, see also IDAC, VDAC
ITM
instrumentation trace macrocell
DFB
digital filter block
LCD
liquid crystal display
DIO
digital input/output, GPIO with only digital
capabilities, no analog. See GPIO.
LIN
Local Interconnect Network, a communications
protocol.
DMA
direct memory access, see also TD
LR
link register
DNL
differential nonlinearity, see also INL
LUT
lookup table
DNU
do not use
LVD
low-voltage detect, see also LVI
DR
port write data registers
LVI
low-voltage interrupt, see also HVI
DSI
digital system interconnect
LVTTL
low-voltage transistor-transistor logic
DWT
data watchpoint and trace
MAC
multiply-accumulate
ECC
error correcting code
MCU
microcontroller unit
ECO
external crystal oscillator
MISO
master-in slave-out
EEPROM
electrically erasable programmable read-only
memory
NC
no connect
NMI
nonmaskable interrupt
NRZ
non-return-to-zero
NVIC
nested vectored interrupt controller
NVL
nonvolatile latch, see also WOL
EMI
electromagnetic interference
EMIF
external memory interface
EOC
end of conversion
EOF
end of frame
EPSR
execution program status register
ESD
electrostatic discharge
ETM
embedded trace macrocell
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
opamp
operational amplifier
PAL
programmable array logic, see also PLD
PC
program counter
PCB
printed circuit board
PGA
programmable gain amplifier
Page 119 of 122
PRELIMINARY
Table 14-1. Acronyms Used in this Document (continued)
Acronym
Description
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
Table 14-1. Acronyms Used in this Document (continued)
Acronym
Description
PHUB
peripheral hub
SOF
start of frame
PHY
physical layer
SPI
PICU
port interrupt control unit
Serial Peripheral Interface, a communications
protocol
PLA
programmable logic array
SR
slew rate
PLD
programmable logic device, see also PAL
SRAM
static random access memory
PLL
phase-locked loop
SRES
software reset
PMDD
package material declaration datasheet
SWD
serial wire debug, a test protocol
POR
power-on reset
SWV
single-wire viewer
PRES
precise low-voltage reset
TD
transaction descriptor, see also DMA
PRS
pseudo random sequence
THD
total harmonic distortion
PS
port read data register
TIA
transimpedance amplifier
PSoC®
Programmable System-on-Chip™
TRM
technical reference manual
PSRR
power supply rejection ratio
TTL
transistor-transistor logic
PWM
pulse-width modulator
TX
transmit
RAM
random-access memory
UART
Universal Asynchronous Transmitter Receiver, a
communications protocol
UDB
universal digital block
RISC
reduced-instruction-set computing
RMS
root-mean-square
RTC
real-time clock
RTL
register transfer language
RTR
RX
USB
Universal Serial Bus
USBIO
USB input/output, PSoC pins used to connect to
a USB port
remote transmission request
VDAC
voltage DAC, see also DAC, IDAC
receive
WDT
watchdog timer
SAR
successive approximation register
WOL
write once latch, see also NVL
SC/CT
switched capacitor/continuous time
WRES
watchdog timer reset
2C
serial clock
SCL
I
SDA
I2C serial data
S/H
sample and hold
SINAD
signal to noise and distortion ratio
SIO
special input/output, GPIO with advanced
features. See GPIO.
SOC
start of conversion
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
XRES
external reset I/O pin
XTAL
crystal
15. Reference Documents
PSoC® 3, PSoC® 5 Architecture TRM
PSoC® 5 Registers TRM
Page 120 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
16. Document Conventions
16.1 Units of Measure
Table 16-1. Units of Measure
Symbol
Unit of Measure
°C
degrees Celsius
dB
decibels
fF
femtofarads
Hz
hertz
KB
1024 bytes
kbps
kilobits per second
Khr
kilohours
kHz
kilohertz
kΩ
kilohms
ksps
kilosamples per second
LSB
least significant bit
Mbps
megabits per second
MHz
megahertz
MΩ
megaohms
Msps
megasamples per second
µA
microamperes
µF
microfarads
µH
microhenrys
µs
microseconds
µV
microvolts
µW
microwatts
mA
milliamperes
ms
milliseconds
mV
millivolts
nA
nanoamperes
ns
nanoseconds
nV
nanovolts
Ω
ohms
pF
picofarads
ppm
parts per million
ps
picoseconds
s
seconds
sps
samples per second
sqrtHz
square root of hertz
V
volts
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Page 121 of 122
PRELIMINARY
PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family
Datasheet
17. Revision History
Description Title: PSoC® 5LP: CY8C58LP Family Datasheet Programmable System-on-Chip (PSoC®)
Document Number: 001-84932
Revision
ECN
Orig. of
Change
Submission
Date
**
3825653
MKEA
12/07/2012
Description of Change
Datasheet for new CY8C58LP family
18. Sales, Solutions, and Legal Information
Worldwide Sales and Design Support
Cypress maintains a worldwide network of offices, solution centers, manufacturer’s representatives, and distributors. To find the office
closest to you, visit us at Cypress Locations.
Products
Automotive
Clocks & Buffers
Interface
Lighting & Power Control
PSoC Solutions
cypress.com/go/automotive
psoc.cypress.com/solutions
cypress.com/go/clocks
PSoC 1 | PSoC 3 | PSoC 5LP
cypress.com/go/interface
cypress.com/go/powerpsoc
cypress.com/go/plc
Memory
Optical & Image Sensing
PSoC
Touch Sensing
USB Controllers
Wireless/RF
cypress.com/go/memory
cypress.com/go/image
cypress.com/go/psoc
cypress.com/go/touch
cypress.com/go/USB
cypress.com/go/wireless
© Cypress Semiconductor Corporation, 2012. The information contained herein is subject to change without notice. Cypress Semiconductor Corporation assumes no responsibility for the use of any
circuitry other than circuitry embodied in a Cypress product. Nor does it convey or imply any license under patent or other rights. Cypress products are not warranted nor intended to be used for medical,
life support, life saving, critical control or safety applications, unless pursuant to an express written agreement with Cypress. Furthermore, Cypress does not authorize its products for use as critical
components in life-support systems where a malfunction or failure may reasonably be expected to result in significant injury to the user. The inclusion of Cypress products in life-support systems
application implies that the manufacturer assumes all risk of such use and in doing so indemnifies Cypress against all charges.
Any Source Code (software and/or firmware) is owned by Cypress Semiconductor Corporation (Cypress) and is protected by and subject to worldwide patent protection (United States and foreign),
United States copyright laws and international treaty provisions. Cypress hereby grants to licensee a personal, non-exclusive, non-transferable license to copy, use, modify, create derivative works of,
and compile the Cypress Source Code and derivative works for the sole purpose of creating custom software and or firmware in support of licensee product to be used only in conjunction with a Cypress
integrated circuit as specified in the applicable agreement. Any reproduction, modification, translation, compilation, or representation of this Source Code except as specified above is prohibited without
the express written permission of Cypress.
Disclaimer: CYPRESS MAKES NO WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WITH REGARD TO THIS MATERIAL, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Cypress reserves the right to make changes without further notice to the materials described herein. Cypress does not
assume any liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit described herein. Cypress does not authorize its products for use as critical components in life-support systems where
a malfunction or failure may reasonably be expected to result in significant injury to the user. The inclusion of Cypress’ product in a life-support systems application implies that the manufacturer
assumes all risk of such use and in doing so indemnifies Cypress against all charges.
Use may be limited by and subject to the applicable Cypress software license agreement.
Document Number: 001-84932 Rev. **
Revised December 7, 2012
Page 122 of 122
CapSense®, PSoC®3, PSoC®5, and PSoC® Creator™ are trademarks and PSoC® is a registered trademark of Cypress Semiconductor Corp. All other trademarks or registered trademarks referenced
herein are property of the respective corporations.
Purchase of I2C components from Cypress or one of its sublicensed Associated Companies conveys a license under the Philips I2C Patent Rights to use these components in an I2C system, provided
that the system conforms to the I2C Standard Specification as defined by Philips.
ARM is a registered trademark, and Keil, and RealView are trademarks, of ARM Limited. All products and company names mentioned in this document may be the trademarks of their respective holders.